Professional Documents
Culture Documents
DCR-TRV240 - 340DCR-TRV240 - 340 L2-v1 L2-v1 (1) .3
DCR-TRV240 - 340DCR-TRV240 - 340 L2-v1 L2-v1 (1) .3
RMT-814
SERVICE MANUAL
US Model
Canadian Model
E Model
Hong Kong Model
Level 2
Ver 1.3 2003. 10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Korea Model
Tourist Model
Argentina Model
Brazilian Model
Photo : DCR-TRV340
DCR-TRV340
M2000 MECHANISM
SPECIFICATIONS
Video camera
recorder
System
Video recording system
2 rotary heads
Helical scanning system
Audio recording system
Rotary heads, PCM system
Quantization: 12 bits (Fs 32 kHz,
stereo 1, stereo 2), 16 bits
(Fs 48 kHz, stereo)
Video signal
NTSC color, EIA standards
Recommended cassette
Hi8/Digital8 video cassette
Recording/playback time (using
120 min. Hi8 video cassette)
SP mode: 1 hour
LP mode: 1 hour and 30 minutes
Fast-forward/rewind time (using
120 min. Hi8 video cassette)
Approx. 5 min.
Viewfinder
Electric Viewfinder, Monochrome
Image device
3 mm (1/6 type CCD)
(Charge Coupled Device)
Gross: Approx. 460 000 pixels
Effective: Approx. 290 000 pixels
Lens
Combined power zoom lens
Filter diameter 37 mm (1 1/2 in.)
25 (Optical), 700 (Digital)
Focal length
2.4 60 mm (1/8 2 3/8 in.)
When converted to a 35 mm still
camera
42 1 050 mm (1 11/16 41 3/8
in.)
Color temperature
Auto
Minimum illumination
4 lx (lux) (F 1.6)
0 lx (lux) (in the NightShot mode)*
* Objects unable to be seen due to
the dark can be shot with
infrared lighting.
Input/output
connectors
S video input/output
4-pin mini DIN
Luminance signal: 1 Vp-p,
75 (ohms), unbalanced
Chrominance signal: 0.286 Vp-p,
75 (ohms), unbalanced
Audio/Video input/output
AV MINIJACK, 1 Vp-p, 75
(ohms), unbalanced, sync negative
327 mV, (at output impedance
more than 47 k (kilohms))
Output impedance with less than
2.2 k (kilohms)/Stereo minijack
( 3.5 mm)
Input impedance more than 47 k
(kilohms)
Headphone jack
Stereo minijack ( 3.5 mm)
USB jack
mini-B
LANC jack
Stereo mini-minijack ( 2.5 mm)
MIC jack
Stereo minijack ( 3.5 mm)
DV input/output
4-pin connector
LCD screen
Picture
6.2 cm (2.5 type)
50.3 37.4 mm (2 1 1/2 in.)
Total dot number
61 600 (280 220)
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
General
Power requirements
7.2 V (battery pack)
8.4 V (AC power adaptor)
Average power consumption
(when using the battery pack)
During camera recording using
LCD
3.8 W
Viewfinder
3.0 W
Operating temperature
0C to 40C (32F to 104F)
Recommended charging
temperature
10C to 30C (50F to 86F)
Storage temperature
20C to + 60C (4F to + 140F)
Dimensions (approx.)
206 101 85 mm
(8 1/8 4 3 3/8 in.)
(w/h/d)
Mass (approx.)
DCR-TRV240:
890 g (1 lb 15 oz)
DCR-TRV340:
900 g (1 lb 15 oz)
excluding the battery pack,
cassette, lens cap and shoulder
strap
DCR-TRV240:
1 030 g (2 lb 4 oz)
DCR-TRV340:
1 040 g (2 lb 4 oz)
including the battery pack
NP-FM30, 120min. Hi8 cassette,
lens cap and shoulder strap
Supplied accessories
See page 3.
Battery pack
AC power adaptor
Power requirements
100 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
Power consumption
23 W
Output voltage
DC OUT: 8.4 V, 1.5 A in the
operating mode
Operating temperature
0C to 40C (32F to 104F)
Storage temperature
20C to + 60C (4F to + 140F)
Dimensions (approx.)
125 39 62 mm
(5 1 9/16 2 1/2 in. ) (w/h/d)
excluding projecting parts
Mass (approx.)
280 g (9.8 oz)
excluding power cord
Memory Stick
(DCR-TRV340 only)
Memory
Flash memory
8MB: MSA-8A
Operating voltage
2.7 3.6 V
Power consumption
Approx. 45 mA in the operating
mode
Approx. 130 A in the standby
mode
Dimensions (approx.)
50 2.8 21.5 mm
(2 1/8 7/8 in.) (w/h/d)
Mass (approx.)
4 g (0.14 oz)
Design and specifications are
subject to change without notice.
CAUTION :
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type.
SAFETY-RELATED COMPONENT WARNING!!
COMPONENTS IDENTIFIED BY MARK 0 OR DOTTED LINE WITH
MARK 0 ON THE SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS AND IN THE PARTS
LIST ARE CRITICAL TO SAFE OPERATION. REPLACE THESE
COMPONENTS WITH SONY PARTS WHOSE PART NUMBERS
APPEAR AS SHOWN IN THIS MANUAL OR IN SUPPLEMENTS
PUBLISHED BY SONY.
SAFETY CHECK-OUT
After correcting the original service problem, perform the following
safety checks before releasing the set to the customer.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Unleaded solder
Boards requiring use of unleaded solder are printed with the leadfree mark (LF) indicating the solder contains no lead.
(Caution: Some printed circuit boards may not come printed with
the lead free mark due to their particular size.)
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SUPPLIED ACCESSORIES
Make sure that the following accessories are supplied with your camcorder.
1
qa
qs
2 AC-L10A/L10B/L10C AC power
adaptor (1), Power cord (1)
3 NP-FM30 battery pack (1)
DCR-TRV240
DCR-TRV340
US, CND, E, HK
Memory Stick
MPEG Movie
a
f
Intelligent
Accessory Shoe
8p
15p
Destination
Remark
Abbreviation
CND : Canadian model
HK : Hong Kong model
KR : Korea model
JE : Tourist model
AR : Argentina model
BR : Brazilian model
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SERVICE NOTE
1.
2.
SELF-DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION
1.
2.
3.
3-1.
3-2.
3-3.
4.
Self-diagnosis Function 8
Self-diagnosis Display 8
Service Mode Display 8
Display Method 8
Switching of Backup No. 8
End of Display 8
Self-diagnosis Code Table 9
1.
GENERAL
2.
DISASSEMBLY
2-1.
2-2.
2-3.
2-4.
2-5.
2-6.
2-7.
2-8.
2-9.
2-10.
2-11.
2-12.
2-13.
2-14.
2-15.
2-16.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3.
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
3-1.
3-2.
3-3.
3-4.
3-5.
3-5.
3-6.
3-7.
3-8.
4.
5.
ADJUSTMENTS
1.
Adjusting items when replacing main parts and boards 5-2
5-1. CAMERA SECTION ADJUSTMENT 5-4
1-1. PREPARATIONS BEFORE ADJUSTMENT
(CAMERA SECTION) 5-4
1-1-1. List of Service Tools 5-4
1-1-2. Preparations 5-5
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2.
2-1.
2-2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
6.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SERVICE NOTE
1.
In this unit, about 10 seconds after power is supplied (8.4V) to the battery terminal using the service power code (J-6082-223-A), the power
is shut off so that the unit cannot operate.
These following two methods are available to prevent this. Take note of which to use during repairs.
Method 1.
Use the DC IN terminal. (Use the AC power adaptor.)
Method 2.
Connect the adjustment remote commander RM-95 (J-6082-053-B) to the LANC jack, and set the HOLD switch to the ADJ side.
2.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Pincette
A
Timing belt
Timing belt
DC power supply
(+5V)
Adjust the bending
of a tape
Loading
motor
Disconnect CN4401 of
VC-276 board
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1.
SELF-DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION
Self-diagnosis Function
2.
Self-diagnosis Display
When problems occur while the unit is operating, the counter of the
viewfinder or Display window shows a 4-digit display consisting
of an alphabet and numbers, which blinks at 3.2 Hz. This 5-character
display indicates the repaired by:, block in which the problem
occurred, and detailed code of the problem.
Display window
C : 3 1 : 11
C:31:11
Blinks at 3.2Hz
31
11
Display window
Repaired by:
C : Corrected by customer
H : Corrected by dealer
E : Corrected by service
engineer
3.
Detailed Code
Block
The service mode display shows up to six self-diagnosis codes shown in the past.
3-1.
Display Method
While pressing the STOP key, set the switch from OFF to VTR or PLAYER, and continue pressing the STOP key for 5 seconds
continuously. The service mode will be displayed, and the counter will show the backup No. and the 5-character self-diagnosis codes.
Viewfinder
Display window
3 C : 3 1 : 11
[3] C : 3 1 : 1 1
Lights up
[3]
Backup No.
C:31:11
Self-diagnosis Codes
Control dial
3-2.
By rotating the control dial, past self-diagnosis codes will be shown in order. The backup No. in the [] indicates the order in which the
problem occurred. (If the number of problems which occurred is less than 6, only the number of problems which occurred will be shown.)
[1] : Occurred first time
[4] : Occurred fourth time
[2] : Occurred second time [5] : Occurred fifth time
[3] : Occurred third time
[6] : Occurred the last time
3-3.
End of Display
Turning OFF the power supply will end the service mode display.
Note: The self-diagnosis display data will be backed up by the coin-type lithium battery (CF-2500 block BT001). When the
CF-2500 block is disconnected, the self-diagnosis display data will be lost by initialization.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4.
Repaired by:
Self-diagnosis Code
Block
Detailed
Function
Code
Symptom/State
C
C
C
0
2
2
4
1
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
0
1
2
3
0
1
0
1
2
3
4
T reel fault.
S reel fault.
Correction
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Repaired by:
Self-diagnosis Code
Block
Detailed
Function
Code
Symptom/State
Correction
10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SECTION 1
GENERAL
Main features
Recording moving or still images, and playing them back
Make sure that the following accessories are supplied with your camcorder.
Getting Started
2 AC-L10A/L10B/L10C AC power
adaptor (1), Power cord (1) (p. 13)
Other uses
V
POWE
R
A
ER ORY
switch to CAMERA
while pressing the
small green button.
CA
M
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
(p. 20)
EM
Recording a picture
4 Press START/STOP.
Your camcorder
starts recording. To
stop recording, press
START/STOP button
again.
(p. 16)
Use the battery pack when using your camcorder outdoors (p. 12).
Open the DC IN
jack cover.
When you purchase your camcorder, the clock setting is set to off. If you want to record the date
and time for a picture, set the clock setting before recording (p. 17).
Viewfinder
When the LCD panel is closed, use the viewfinder with your eye
against the eyecup.
The picture in the viewfinder is black and white.
REW
V
R
POWE
CA
M
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
straight as far as
possible into the
cassette
compartment with
the window facing
up.
Push the center of
the cassette back to
insert the cassette.
EM
A
ER ORY
1 Slide OPEN/EJECT
Note
Do not pick up your camcorder by
holding the viewfinder, the LCD
panel, or the battery pack.
1-1
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Getting Started
The instructions in this manual are for the two models listed in the table below. Before
you start reading this manual and operating your camcorder, check the model number
by looking at the bottom of your camcorder. The DCR-TRV340 is the model used for
illustration purposes. Otherwise, the model name is indicated in the illustrations. Any
differences in operation are clearly indicated in the text, for example, DCR-TRV340
only.
As you read through this manual, buttons and settings on your camcorder are shown in
capital letters.
TRV340
MEMORY mark*
(on the POWER switch)
Self-timer
z Provided
Not provided
[a]
[b]
[c]
[d]
Getting Started
The LCD screen and the finder are manufactured using extremely high-precision
technology so over 99.99% of the pixels are operational for effective use.
However, there may be some tiny black points and/or bright points (white, red,
blue or green in color) that constantly appear on the LCD screen and the finder.
These points are normal in the manufacturing process and do not affect the
recording in any way.
Do not let your camcorder become wet. Keep your camcorder away from rain and sea
water. Letting your camcorder become wet may cause your camcorder to malfunction.
Sometimes this malfunction cannot be repaired [a].
Never leave your camcorder exposed to temperatures above 60C (140F), such as in a
car parked in the sun or under direct sunlight [b].
Be careful when placing the camera near a window or outdoors. Exposing the LCD
screen, the finder or the lens to direct sunlight for long periods may cause
malfunctions [c].
Do not directly shoot the sun. Doing so might cause your camcorder to malfunction.
Take pictures of the sun in low light conditions such as dusk [d].
* The models with MEMORY marked on the POWER switch is provided with memory
functions. See page 115 for details.
Copyright precautions
Television programs, films, video tapes, and other materials may be copyrighted.
Unauthorized recording of such materials may be contrary to the provision of the
copyright laws.
10
11
(1) Open the DC IN jack cover and connect the AC power adaptor supplied with
your camcorder to the DC IN jack with the plugs v mark facing up.
(2) Connect the power cord to the AC power adaptor.
(3) Connect the power cord to a wall outlet.
(4) Set the POWER switch to OFF (CHG). Charging begins. The remaining battery
time is indicated in minutes on the display window.
1
2
Getting Started
V
POWER
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
CA
M
EM
A
ER ORY
BATT (battery)
release lever
1
2
If you install the large-capacity battery pack
If you install the NP-FM70/QM71/FM90/QM91/FM91 battery pack on your
camcorder, extend its viewfinder.
The number in the illustration of the display window may differ from that on your
camcorder.
12
13
1-2
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Note
Prevent metallic objects from coming into contact with the metal parts on the DC plug
of the AC power adaptor. This may cause a short-circuit, damaging the AC power
adaptor.
Battery pack
NP-FM30 (supplied)
145 (85)
150 (90)
NP-FM70
240 (180)
NP-QM71
260 (200)
NP-FM90
330 (270)
NP-QM91/FM91
360 (300)
Getting Started
NP-FM50
The charging time may increase if the batterys temperature is extremely high or low
because of the ambient temperature.
Approximate number of minutes to charge an empty battery pack at 25C (77F)
Recording time
Battery pack
NP-FM30 (supplied)
NP-FM50
NP-FM70
NP-QM71
NP-FM90
NP-QM91/FM91
If the power may go off although the remaining battery time indicator indicates
that the battery pack has enough power to operate
Charge the battery pack fully again so that the indication on the remaining battery time
indicator is correct.
When you use the AC power adaptor
Place the AC power adaptor near a wall outlet. If any trouble occurs with this unit,
disconnect the plug from the wall outlet as soon as possible to cut off the power.
Recording with
the viewfinder
Continuous*
Typical**
100
55
165
95
345
200
400
230
520
300
605
350
Recording with
the LCD screen
Continuous*
Typical**
80
45
130
75
270
155
315
180
410
235
475
275
Approximate continuous recording time at 25C (77F). The battery life will be
shorter if you use your camcorder in a cold environment.
** Approximate number of minutes when recording while you repeat recording start/
stop, zooming and turning the power on/off. The actual battery life may be shorter.
Playing time
Battery pack
NP-FM30 (supplied)
NP-FM50
NP-FM70
NP-QM71
NP-FM90
NP-QM91/FM91
TM
SERIES
Playing time
on LCD screen
80
130
270
315
410
475
Playing time
with LCD closed
110
180
370
430
560
645
14
When you use your camcorder for a long time, we recommend that you power it from a
wall outlet using the AC power adaptor.
(1) Open the DC IN jack cover, and connect the AC power adaptor to the DC IN
jack on your camcorder with the plugs v mark facing up.
(2) Connect the power cord to the AC power adaptor.
(3) Connect the power cord to a wall outlet.
(1) Set the POWER switch to CAMERA or MEMORY (DCR-TRV340 only), and
then press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select CLOCK SET in
dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to adjust the desired year, then press the dial.
(4) Set the month, day and hour by turning the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial and
pressing the dial.
(5) Set the minute by turning the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial and pressing the dial by
the time signal. The clock starts to move.
(6) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
2, 3
Getting Started
Set the date and time settings when you use your camcorder for the first time.
CLOCK SET will be displayed each time that you set the POWER switch to
CAMERA/MEMORY (DCR-TRV340 only) unless you set the date and time settings.
If you do not use your camcorder for about half a year, the date and time settings may
be cleared from memory (bars may appear) because the built-in rechargeable battery
installed in your camcorder will have been discharged (p. 194).
Set the year, then the month, the day, the hour and then the minute.
15
1,6
MENU
PRECAUTION
The set is not disconnected from the AC power source (house current) as long as it is
connected to the wall outlet, even if the set itself has been turned off.
SETUP MENU
CLOCK SET
USB STREAM
LTR SIZE
LANGUAGE
DEMO MODE
RETURN
: :
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
Notes
The AC power adaptor can supply power even if the battery pack is attached to your
camcorder.
The DC IN jack has source priority. This means that the battery pack cannot supply
any power if the power cord is connected to the DC IN jack, even when the power
cord is not plugged into a wall outlet.
2002 JAN
12 00 AM
SETUP MENU
CLOCK SET
USB STREAM
2002 JUL 4
LTR SIZE
LANGUAGE
DEMO MODE
RETURN
5 30 PM
[MENU] : END
16
SETUP MENU
CLOCK SET
USB STREAM
2002 JAN 1
LTR SIZE
LANGUAGE
DEMO MODE
RETURN
12 00 AM
2002 JAN
12 00 AM
SETUP MENU
CLOCK SET JUL 4 2002
5:30:00 PM
USB STREAM
LTR SIZE
LANGUAGE
DEMO MODE
RETURN
[MENU] : END
17
1-3
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
/Digital8
video cassettes.
Getting Started
4,5
4
5
To eject a cassette
Follow the procedure above, and take out the cassette in step 3.
Notes
Do not press the cassette compartment down. Doing so may cause a malfunction.
Your camcorder records pictures in the Digital8 system.
The recording time when you use your camcorder is half of indicated time on Hi8
tape. If you select the LP mode in the menu settings, 3/4 of indicated time on Hi8
tape.
If you use standard 8 tape, be sure to play back the tape on your camcorder. Mosaic
pattern noise may appear when you play back standard 8 tape on other camcorders
(including other DCR-TRV240/TRV340).
The cassette compartment may not be closed when you press any part of the lid other
mark.
than the
To prevent accidental erasure
Slide the write-protect tab on the cassette to expose the red mark.
18
19
Recording Basics
Recording a picture
Recording a picture
3
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
V
POWE
R
CA
M
EM
A
ER ORY
Recording Basics
(1) Remove the lens cap by pressing both knobs on its sides and attach the lens
cap to the grip strap.
(2) Install the power source and insert a cassette. See Step 1 to Step 3 for more
information (p. 12 to 19).
(3) Set the POWER switch to CAMERA while pressing the small green button.
This sets your camcorder to the standby mode.
(4) Open the LCD panel while pressing OPEN. The viewfinder automatically
turns off.
(5) Press START/STOP. Your camcorder starts recording. The REC indicator
appears on the screen. The camera recording lamp located on the front of your
camcorder lights up. To stop recording, press START/STOP again.
The recording lamp lights up in the viewfinder when you record with the
viewfinder.
When you record in the SP and LP modes on one tape or you record some scenes
in the LP mode
The transition between scenes may not be smooth.
The playback picture may be distorted or the time code may not be written properly
between scenes.
50min
SP
REC 0:00:01
Recording data
The recording data (date/time or various settings when recorded) are not displayed
while recording. However, they are recorded automatically onto the tape. To display
the recording data, press DATA CODE on the Remote Commander during playback.
After recording
Camera
recording lamp
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Microphone
Notes
Fasten the grip strap firmly.
Do not touch the built-in microphone during recording.
20
21
1-4
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Recording a picture
Recording a picture
The LCD panel can be opened up to 90 degrees. The LCD panel moves about 90 degrees
to the viewfinder side and about 180 degrees to the lens side.
Move the power zoom lever a little for a slower zoom. Move it further for a faster zoom.
Using the zoom function sparingly results in better-looking recordings.
T side: for telephoto (subject appears closer)
W side: for wide-angle (subject appears farther away)
T
W
90
Recording Basics
180
When closing the LCD panel, set it vertically until it clicks, and swing it into the
camcorder body.
To use zoom greater than 25
Zoom greater than 25 is performed digitally. To activate digital zoom, select the digital
zoom power in D ZOOM in the menu settings. (p. 104)
The digital zoom function is set to OFF as the default setting.
Note
When using the LCD screen except in the mirror mode, the viewfinder automatically
turns off.
When you use the LCD screen outdoors in direct sunlight
The LCD screen may be difficult to see. If this happens, we recommend that you use the
viewfinder.
22
23
Recording a picture
Recording a picture
Lift up the viewfinder and move the viewfinder lens adjustment lever.
Recording Basics
If you record pictures with the LCD panel closed, check the picture with the viewfinder.
Adjust the viewfinder lens to your eyesight so that the indicators in the viewfinder
come into sharp focus.
Viewfinder backlight
You can change the brightness of the backlight. Select VF B.L. in the menu settings
(p. 104). Even if you adjust the VF B.L., the recorded picture will not be affected.
Pictures in the mirror mode
The picture on the LCD is a mirror-image. However, the picture will be normal when
recorded.
During recording in the mirror mode
ZERO SET MEMORY on the Remote Commander does not work.
24
25
1-5
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Recording a picture
Recording a picture
When you shoot a subject with the light source behind the subject or a subject with a
light background, use the backlight function.
Recording mode
STBY/REC
50min
SP
REC 0:00:01
Recording Basics
Format
Remaining tape
This appears after the POWER switch is set to CAMERA
for a while.
JUL
4 2002
12:05:56 PM
Time
This is displayed for five seconds after the POWER switch is
set to CAMERA or MEMORY (DCR-TRV340 only).
BACK LIGHT
Date
This is displayed for five seconds after the POWER switch is
set to CAMERA or MEMORY (DCR-TRV340 only).
26
27
Recording a picture
Recording a picture
While using the NightShot function, you can not use the following functions:
Exposure
PROGRAM AE
Recording Basics
Notes
Do not use the NightShot mode in bright places (e.g. outdoors in the daytime). This
may cause your camcorder to malfunction.
When you keep NIGHTSHOT set to ON in normal recording, the picture may be
recorded in incorrect or unnatural colors.
If focusing is difficult with the autofocus mode when using the NightShot function,
focus manually.
You cannot use the Color Slow Shutter function in dark places where the illumination
is 0 lux.
NIGHTSHOT
OFF
While using the Super NightShot or Color Slow Shutter function, you cannot use
the following functions:
Fader
Digital effects
Exposure
PROGRAM AE
Memory Photo recording
ON
SUPER NS
COLOR SLOW S
Infrared rays
emitter
NightShot Light
NightShot Light rays are infrared and so are invisible. The maximum shooting distance
using the NightShot Light is about 3 m (10 feet).
28
29
1-6
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Checking recordings
END SEARCH/EDITSEARCH/Rec Review
Recording a picture
You can use these buttons to check the recorded picture or shoot so that the transition
between the last recorded scene and the next scene you record is smooth.
Self-timer recording
DCR-TRV340 only
Recording with the self-timer starts in 10 seconds automatically.
You can also use the Remote Commander for this operation.
END SEARCH
Recording Basics
(1) In the standby mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select SELFTIMER in
, then press the
dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(4) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
(5) Press START/STOP.
The self-timer starts counting down from 10 with a beep. In the last two
seconds of the countdown, the beep gets faster, then recording starts
automatically.
To stop recording, press START/STOP again.
EDITSEARCH
END SEARCH
START/STOP
You can go to the end of the recorded section after you record.
In the standby mode, press END SEARCH.
The last five seconds of the recorded section are played back and your camcorder
returns to the standby mode. You can monitor the sound from the speaker or
headphones.
START/STOP
3
1,4
MENU
EDITSEARCH
CAMERA SET
SELFTIMER
OFF
D ZOOM
ON
PHOTO REC
16 : 9WIDE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
INT. REC
RETURN
[MENU] : END
Rec Review
You can check the last recorded section.
30
31
Playback Basics
You can monitor the playback picture on the LCD screen. If you close the LCD panel,
you can monitor the playback picture in the viewfinder.
You can control playback using the Remote Commander supplied with your
camcorder.
Notes
END SEARCH, EDITSEARCH and Rec Review work only for tapes recorded in the
Digital8 system.
If you start recording after using the end search function, occasionally, the transition
between the last scene you recorded and the next scene may not be smooth.
Once you eject the cassette after you have recorded on the tape, the end search
function does not work.
If a tape has a blank portion between recorded portions
The end search function may not work correctly.
Playback Basics
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
5
REW
PLAY
2
R
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
V
POWE
CA
M
EM
A
ER ORY
6
VOLUME
3
1
To stop playback
Press x.
32
33
1-7
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DISPLAY
Recording data
Recording data is your camcorders information when you have recorded. In the
recording mode, the recording data will not be displayed.
When you use data code function, bars (-- -- --) appear if:
A blank portion of the tape is being played back.
The tape is unreadable due to tape damage or noise.
The tape was recorded by a camcorder without the date and time set.
DISPLAY
Data code
When you connect your camcorder to the TV, the data code appears on the TV screen.
0:00:23:01
JUL 4 2002
12:05:56 PM
Various settings
50min
Playback Basics
DATA CODE
0:00:23:01
AUTO
60 AWB
9dB
F1.6
[a]
[b]
[c]
[d]
[e]
[f]
[g]
34
35
Viewing recordings on TV
Press y on the Remote Commander during playback. For slow playback in the reverse
direction, press
, then press y on the Remote Commander. To resume normal
playback, press N.
Open the jack cover. Connect your camcorder to the TV using the A/V connecting cable
supplied with your camcorder. Then, set the TV/VCR selector on the TV to VCR.
Press 2 on the Remote Commander during playback. For double speed playback in the
reverse direction, press , then press 2 on the Remote Commander. To resume
normal playback, press N.
Playback Basics
Connect your camcorder to your TV with the A/V connecting cable supplied with your
camcorder to watch playback pictures on the TV screen. You can operate the video
control buttons in the same way as when you monitor playback pictures on the LCD
screen. When monitoring playback pictures on the TV screen, we recommend that you
power your camcorder from a wall outlet using the AC power adaptor (p. 16). Refer to
the operating instructions of your TV.
S VIDEO
AUDIO / VIDEO
Press END SEARCH in the stop mode. The last five seconds of the recorded section
plays back and stops.
IN
S VIDEO
VIDEO
AUDIO
: Signal flow
Connect your camcorder to the LINE IN input on the VCR by using the A/V connecting
cable supplied with your camcorder. Set the input selector on the VCR to LINE.
Connect the yellow plug of the A/V connecting cable to the video input jack and the
white or the red plug to the audio input jack on the VCR or the TV. If you connect the
white plug, the sound is L (left) signal. If you connect the red plug, the sound is R
(right) signal.
36
37
1-8
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Before operation
Set PHOTO REC to TAPE in the menu settings. (The default setting is MEMORY.)
(DCR-TRV340 only) (p. 104)
(1) In the standby mode, keep pressing PHOTO lightly until a still image appears.
The CAPTURE indicator appears. Recording does not start yet.
To change the still image, release PHOTO, select a still image again, and then
press and hold PHOTO lightly.
(2) Press PHOTO deeper.
The still image on the screen is recorded for about seven seconds. The sound
during those seven seconds is also recorded.
The still image is displayed on the screen until recording is completed.
CAPTURE
PHOTO
1
2
PHOTO
Notes
During Tape Photo recording, you cannot change the mode or setting.
You cannot use PHOTO during the following operations:
Fader
Digital effects
When recording a still image, do not shake your camcorder. The image may fluctuate.
If you record a moving subject with tape photo recording function
The image may fluctuate when you play back the still image on other equipment.
This is not a malfunction.
To use tape photo recording function using the Remote Commander
Press PHOTO on the Remote Commander. Your camcorder records an image on the
screen immediately.
38
39
You can record a 16:9 wide picture to watch on a 16:9 wide-screen TV (16:9WIDE).
Black bands appear on the screen during recording in 16:9 WIDE mode [a]. The picture
during playing back on a normal TV [b] or a wide-screen TV [c] are compressed in the
widthwise direction. If you set the screen mode of the wide-screen TV to the full mode,
you can watch pictures of normal images [d].
Self-timer recording
DCR-TRV340 only
You can record still images on tapes with the self-timer.
You can also use the Remote Commander for this operation.
[a]
[b]
[d]
16:9WIDE
[c]
(1) In the standby mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the dial.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC to select 16:9 WIDE in
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC to select ON, then press the dial.
PHOTO
5
PHOTO
(1) In the standby mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select SELFTIMER in
dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(4) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
(5) Press PHOTO deeper.
The self-timer starts counting down from 10 with a beep sound. In the last two
seconds of the countdown, the beep gets faster, then recording starts
automatically.
3
1,4
MENU
CAMERA SET
SELFTIMER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16:9 WIDE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
INT. REC
RETURN
CAMERA SET
OFF
SELFTIMER
ON
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9WIDE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
INT. REC
RETURN
MENU
OFF
ON
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
Note
The self-timer recording mode is automatically canceled when:
Self-timer recording is finished.
The POWER switch is set to OFF (CHG) or VCR.
During recording
You cannot select or cancel the wide mode.
When you cancel the wide mode, set your camcorder to the standby mode and then set
16:9WIDE to OFF in the menu settings.
Connection for a TV
Pictures recorded in the 16:9WIDE mode automatically appear on the TV screen at full
size when:
You connect your camcorder to a TV that is compatible with the video ID (ID-1/ID-2)
system.
You connect your camcorder to the S video jack on the TV.
40
1-9
41
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can fade in or out to give your recording a more professional appearance.
ID-1 system
The ID-1 system sends aspect ratio (screen horizontal/vertical ratio) information (16:9,
4:3, or letter box) with video signals. If you connect a TV compatible with the ID-1
system, the screen size is automatically selected.
[a]
ID-2 system
The ID-2 system sends a copyright protection signal with ID-1 signals inserted between
video signals when you connect your camcorder to other equipment by an A/V
connecting cable.
STBY
REC
FADER
If 16:9WIDE is set to ON
The SteadyShot function does not work. If you set 16:9WIDE to ON in the menu settings
flashes and the SteadyShot function does
when the SteadyShot function is working,
not function.
M.FADER
(mosaic)
BOUNCE 1) 2)
OVERLAP 2)
WIPE 2)
DOT 2)
[b]
STBY
REC
MONOTONE
When fading in, the picture gradually changes from black-and-white to color.
When fading out, the picture gradually changes from color to black-and-white.
1)
2)
You can use this function when D ZOOM is set to OFF in the menu settings.
Fade in only
42
43
While using the bounce function, you cannot use the following functions:
Focus
Zoom
Picture effects
1
FADER
FADER
44
45
1-10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can digitally process pictures to obtain special effects like those in films or on the
TV.
You can add special effects to recorded picture using the various digital functions.
Sound is recorded normally.
STILL
You can record a still image so that it is superimposed on a moving picture.
[b]
[c]
[d]
[e]
LUMI. (LUMINANCEKEY)
You can swap a brighter area in a still image with a moving picture.
TRAIL
You can record the picture so that an incidental image like a trail is left.
[f]
Still image
Moving picture
Still image
Moving picture
[a]
STILL
LUMI.
MANUAL SET
PROGRAM AE
P EFFECT
D EFFECT
FLASH MODE
FLASH LVL
N. S. LIGHT
AUTO SHTR
RETURN
OFF
NEG. ART
SEPIA
B&W
SOLARIZE
SLIM
STRETCH
PASTEL
MOSAIC
[MENU] : END
MENU
46
47
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
The rate of the still image you want to superimpose on the moving
picture
FLASH
LUMI.
TRAIL
SLOW SHTR
Shutter speed. The larger the shutter speed number, the slower the
shutter speed becomes.
OLD MOVIE
No adjustment necessary
The more bars there are on the screen, the stronger the digital effect. The bars
appear in the following modes: STILL, FLASH, LUMI. and TRAIL.
Shutter speed
1/30
1/15
1/8
1/4
Notes
The following functions do not work during digital effects:
Fader
Photo recording
Super NightShot
Color Slow Shutter
The PROGRAM AE function does not work in the slow shutter mode.
The following functions do not work in the old movie mode:
Wide mode
Picture effects
PROGRAM AE
MENU
MANUAL SET
D EFFECT
OFF
STILL
FLASH
LUMI.
TRAIL
SLOW SHTR
OLD MOVIE
[MENU] : END
MANUAL SET
D EFFECT
LUMI.
IIIIIIII
[MENU] : END
48
49
1-11
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can select the PROGRAM AE (Auto Exposure) mode to suit your specific shooting
requirements.
Spotlight
This mode prevents peoples faces, for example, from appearing excessively white
when shooting subjects lit by strong light in the theater.
Soft portrait
This mode brings out the subject while creating a soft background for subjects such as
people or flowers.
MANUAL SET
PROGRAM AE
P EFFECT
D EFFECT
FLASH MODE
FLASH LVL
N. S LIGHT
AUTO SHTR
RETURN
AUTO
SPOTLIGHT
PORTRAIT
SPORTS
BEACH&SKI
SUNSETMOON
LANDSCAPE
[MENU] : END
MENU
Landscape
This mode is for when you are recording distant subjects such as mountains and
prevents your camcorder from focusing on glass or metal mesh in windows when you
are recording a subject behind glass or a screen.
Sports lesson
This mode minimizes camera shake on fast-moving subjects such as in tennis or golf.
50
51
Focusing manually
You can manually adjust and set the exposure. Normally, exposure is automatically
adjusted.
Adjust the exposure manually in the following cases:
When the subject is backlit
When shooting bright subjects and dark backgrounds
When recording dark pictures (e.g. night scenes) faithfully
You can gain better results by manually adjusting the focus in the following cases.
Normally, focus is automatically adjusted:
The autofocus mode is not effective when shooting:
Subjects through glass coated with water droplets.
Horizontal stripes.
Subjects with little contrast with backgrounds such as walls and sky.
When you want to change the focus from a subject in the foreground to a subject in
the background.
Shooting a stationary subject when using a tripod.
EXPOSURE
2
To return to the automatic exposure mode
Press EXPOSURE to turn off the indicator.
Note
When you adjust the exposure manually, the following functions do not work:
BACKLIGHT
Color Slow Shutter
FOCUS
52
53
1-12
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Interval recording
Interval recording
Example
1s
[a]
1s
9 min 59 s
[a]
[b]
10 min
9 min 59 s
[b]
10 min
2,3
CAMERA SET
SELFT I MER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9W I DE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
I NT. REC
OFF
RETURN
CAMERA SET
SELFT I MER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9W I DE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
I NT. REC
ON
RETURN
OFF
SET
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
CAMERA SET
SELFT I MER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9W I DE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC
I NT. REC
ON
RETURN
CAMERA SET
I NT. REC
I NTERVAL
REC T I ME
RETURN
30SEC
CAMERA SET
I NT. REC
I NTERVAL
REC T I ME
RETURN
30SEC
1M I N
5M I N
10M I N
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
[MENU] : END
STBY
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
CAMERA SET
I NT. REC
I NTERVAL
REC T I ME
RETURN
CAMERA SET
I NT. REC
I NTERVAL
REC T I ME
RETURN
0 . 5SEC
I NTERVAL
MENU
[MENU] : END
0 . 5SEC
1SEC
1 . 5SEC
2SEC
[MENU] : END
54
55
Superimposing a title
You can make a recording with a stop-motion animated effect using frame recording.
To create this effect, alternately move the subject a little and make a frame recording.
We recommend that you use a tripod, and operate your camcorder using the Remote
Commander after step 5.
You can select one of eight preset titles and two custom titles (p. 59). You can also select
the language, color, size and position of titles.
(1) In the standby mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select FRAME REC in
, then press the
dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(4) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
The FRAME REC indicator appears.
(5) Press START/STOP to start frame recording. Your camcorder makes a
recording for about six frames, and returns to recording standby.
(6) Move the subject, and repeat step 5.
VACATION
(1) In the standby mode, press TITLE to display the title menu. The title menu
display appears on the screen.
, then press the dial.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired title, then press the dial.
The titles are displayed in the language you selected.
(4) Change the color, size, or position, if necessary.
1 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select COLOR, SIZE, or POSITION, then
press the dial. The selected item appears on the screen.
2 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired item, then press the
dial.
3 Repeat steps 1 and 2 until the title is laid out as desired.
(5) Press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial again to complete the setting.
(6) Press START/STOP to start recording.
(7) When you want to stop recording the title, press TITLE.
1
4
STBY
FRAME REC
MENU
CAMERA SET
SELFT I MER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9W I DE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC OFF
ON
I NT. REC
RETURN
CAMERA SET
SELFT I MER
D ZOOM
PHOTO REC
16 : 9W I DE
STEADYSHOT
FRAME REC ON
I NT. REC
RETURN
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
TITLE
PRESET TITLE
HELLO!
HAPPY BIRTHDAY
HAPPY HOLIDAYS
CONGRATULATIONS!
OUR SWEET BABY
WEDDING
VACATION
THE END
[TITLE] : END
[TITLE] : END
Note
The remaining tape time is not indicated correctly if you use this function continuously.
PRESET TITLE
HELLO!
HAPPY BIRTHDAY
HAPPY HOLIDAYS
CONGRATULATIONS!
OUR SWEET BABY
WEDDING
VACATION
THE END
PRESET TITLE
HELLO!
HAPPY BIRTHDAY
HAPPY HOLIDAYS
CONGRATULATIONS!
OUR SWEET BABY
WEDDING
VACATION
THE END
RETURN
[TITLE] : END
SIZE
SMALL
SIZE
PRESET TITLE
HELLO!
HAPPY BIRTHDAY
HAPPY HOLIDAYS
CONGRATULATIONS!
OUR SWEET BABY
WEDDING
VACATION
THE END
RETURN
[TITLE] : END
TITLE
VACATION
[TITLE] : END
TITLE
LARGE
VACATION
VACATION
[TITLE] : END
56
57
1-13
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Superimposing a title
To superimpose the title while you are recording
You can make up to two titles and store them in your camcorder. Each title can have up
to 20 characters.
Press TITLE while you are recording, and carry out steps 2 to 5. When you press the
SEL/PUSH EXEC dial at step 5, the title is recorded.
in step 2.
Title setting
The title color changes as follows:
WHITE y YELLOW y VIOLET y RED y CYAN y GREEN y BLUE
The title size changes as follows:
SMALL y LARGE
You cannot input 13 characters or more in LARGE size. If you input more than 12
characters, the title size returns to SMALL even you select LARGE.
The title position changes as follows:
1y 2y 3y 4y 5y 6y 7y 8y 9
The larger the position number, the lower the title is positioned.
When you select the title size LARGE, you cannot choose position 9.
1
2
TITLE
PRESET TITLE
HELLO!
HAPPY BIRTHDAY
HAPPY HOLIDAYS
CONGRATULATIONS!
OUR SWEET BABY
WEDDING
VACATION
THE END
TITLE SET
CUSTOM1 SET
CUSTOM2 SET
RETURN
TITLE SET
CUSTOM1 SET
CUSTOM2 SET
[TITLE] : END
[TITLE] : END
[TITLE] : END
TITLE SET
P1
____________________
TITLE SET
CUSTOM1 SET
CUSTOM2 SET
RETURN
ABCDE 12345
FGHIJ 67890
KLMNO
PQRST
UVWXY
Z& ?!
. , /
[TITLE] : END
[TITLE] : END
$FDM
i:
[ C ]
[ cP2 ]
[ SET ]
P1
TITLE SET
____________________
P1
TITLE SET
____________________
ABCDE 1 2 3 4 5 $FDM
FGHIJ 6 7 8 9 0 i :
KLMNO [ C ]
PQRST [ cP2 ]
UVWXY [ SET ]
Z& ? !
. , /
[TITLE] : END
ABCDE 1 2 3 4 5 $FDM
FGHIJ 6 7 8 9 0 i :
KLMNO [ C ]
PQRST [ cP2 ]
UVWXY [ SET ]
Z& ? !
. , /
[TITLE] : END
TITLE SET
P1
___________________
P1
TITLE SET
S_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _
ABCDE 1 2 3 4 5 $FDM
FGHIJ 6 7 8 9 0 i :
KLMNO [ C ]
PQRST [ cP2 ]
UVWXY [ SET ]
Z& ? !
. , /
[TITLE] : END
ABCDE 1 2 3 4 5 $FDM
FGHIJ 6 7 8 9 0 i :
KLMNO [ C ]
PQRST [ cP2 ]
UVWXY [ SET ]
Z& ? !
. , /
[TITLE] : END
58
59
Inserting a scene
You can insert a scene in the middle of a recorded tape by setting the start and end
points. The previously recorded frames between these start and end points will be
erased.
Use the Remote Commander for this operation.
In step 3, select CUSTOM1 SET or CUSTOM2 SET, depending on which title you want
to change, then press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial.
Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select [C], then press the dial to delete the title. The
last character is erased. Enter the new title as desired.
If you select [
]
The menu for selecting alphabet and Russian characters appear. Select [
to the previous screen.
[a]
[b]
] to return
(1) In the standby mode, keep pressing EDITSEARCH, and release the button at
the insert end point [b].
(2) Press ZERO SET MEMORY on the Remote Commander.
The ZERO SET MEMORY indicator flashes and the counter resets to zero.
(3) Keep pressing the 7 side of EDITSEARCH and release the button at the
insert start point [a].
(4) Press START/STOP to start recording.
The scene is inserted. Recording stops automatically near the counter zero
point. Your camcorder returns to the standby mode.
To erase a character
Select [C]. The last character is erased.
To enter a space
Select [Z& ?!], then select the blank part.
If you take three minutes or longer to enter characters in the standby mode while
a cassette is in your camcorder
The power automatically goes off. The characters you have entered remain stored in
memory. Set the POWER switch to OFF (CHG) once, and turn it to CAMERA again,
then proceed from step 1.
We recommend setting the POWER switch to VCR or removing the cassette so that
your camcorder does not automatically turn off while you are entering title characters.
ZERO SET
MEMORY
EDITSEARCH
Notes
The zero set memory function works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
The picture and the sound may be distorted at the end of the inserted section when it
is played back.
If a tape has a blank portion between recorded portions
The zero set memory function may not work correctly.
60
61
1-14
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
During playback, you can process a scene using the following digital effect functions:
STILL, FLASH, LUMI. and TRAIL.
(1) In the playback or playback pause mode, press MENU to display the menu
settings.
, then press the dial.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select P EFFECT in
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired picture effect mode, then
press the dial.
For details of each picture effect function, see page 46.
(1) In the playback mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the dial.
(2) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select D EFFECT in
(3) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired digital effect mode, then press
the dial.
The bars appear on the screen.
In the STILL or LUMI. mode, the picture is captured and is stored in memory
as a still image at the time you press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to adjust the effect.
For details of each digital effect function, see page 47.
MANUAL SET
P EFFECT
D EFFECT
RETURN
OFF
NEG. ART
SEPIA
B&W
SOLARIZE
[MENU] : END
MENU
MENU
2
To cancel the picture effect
Set P EFFECT to OFF in the menu settings.
MANUAL SET
D EFFECT
OFF
ST ILL
FLASH
LUMI.
TRAIL
[MENU] : END
Notes
Picture effect functions work only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
You cannot process externally input scenes using the picture effect functions.
You cannot record pictures on a tape on your camcorder when you have processed
the picture using the picture effect function. However, you can record pictures on a
Memory Stick (DCR-TRV340 only) (p. 133, 140), or on a VCR using your camcorder
as a player.
MANUAL SET
D EFFECT
LUMI.
IIIIIIII
[MENU] : END
62
63
Notes
The PB ZOOM function works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
You cannot process externally input scenes using the PB ZOOM function.
You cannot record images on a tape on your camcorder when you have processed the
image using the PB ZOOM function. However, you can record images on a Memory
Stick (DCR-TRV340 only) (p. 133), or on a VCR using your camcorder as a player.
(1) In the playback or playback pause mode, press PB ZOOM. The image is
enlarged, and R r indicators which showing the direction to move the image
appear on the screen.
(2) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to move the enlarged image, then press the dial.
R : The image moves downwards.
r : The image moves upwards.
(3) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to move the enlarged image, then press the dial.
T : The image moves rightward (Turn the dial downwards.)
t : The image moves leftward (Turn the dial upwards.)
(4) For DCR-TRV340 only:
Adjust the zoom ratio by the power zoom lever.
You can enlarge the image from 1.1 times up to five times its size.
W : Decreases the zoom ratio.
T : Increase the zoom ratio.
4
2
PB ZOOM
5.0
[EXEC] : T t
PB ZOOM
5.0
1
PB ZOOM
[EXEC] : r R
64
65
1-15
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can automatically search for the point where the recording date changes and start
playback from that point (date search).
Use the Remote Commander for this operation.
Use this function to check where recording dates change or to edit the tape at each
recording date.
DISPLAY
m
JUL 4 2002
JUL 5 2002
[a]
[b]
DEC 31 2002
[c]
ZERO SET
MEMORY
N
(3) When the current position is [b], press . to search towards [a] or press >
to search towards [c]. Your camcorder automatically starts playback at the
point where the date changes.
Each time you press . or > your camcorder searches for the previous or
next date.
Notes
The zero set memory function works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
When you press ZERO SET MEMORY before rewinding the tape, the zero set memory
function is canceled.
There may be a discrepancy of several seconds from the time code.
SEARCH
MODE
DATE 00
SEARCH
DATE 01
SEARCH
To stop searching
Press x.
Notes
The date search function works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
If one days recording is less than two minutes, your camcorder may not accurately
find the point where the recording date changes.
If a tape has a blank portion between recorded portions
The date search function may not work correctly.
66
You can search for the recorded still image recorded on tape (photo search).
You can also search for still images one after another and display each image for five
seconds automatically (photo scan).
Use the Remote Commander for these operations.
Scanning photo
(1) Set the POWER switch to VCR.
(2) Press SEARCH MODE on the Remote Commander repeatedly until the photo
scan indicator appears on the screen.
The indicator changes as follows:
DATE SEARCH t PHOTO SEARCH t PHOTO SCAN t (no indicator)
SEARCH
MODE
(3) Press . or > to select the photo for playback. Each time you press . or
> your camcorder searches for the previous or next photo. Your camcorder
automatically starts playback from the photo.
PHOTO 00
SEARCH
67
PHOTO 01
SEARCH
To stop scanning
Press x.
Note
The photo search and photo scan functions work only for tapes recorded in the Digital8
system.
If a tape has a blank portion between recorded portions
The photo search/photo scan function may not work correctly.
To stop searching
Press x.
68
69
1-16
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Editing
Dubbing a tape
Dubbing a tape
You can dub or edit on the VCR connected to your camcorder using your camcorder as
a player.
Connect your camcorder to the VCR using the A/V connecting cable supplied with
your camcorder.
Before operation
Set DISPLAY to LCD in the menu settings. (The default setting is LCD.)
Press the following buttons to make the indicators disappear so that they will not be
superimposed on the edited tape:
DISPLAY
DATA CODE on the Remote Commander
SEARCH MODE on the Remote Commander
Editing
(1) Insert a blank tape (or a tape you want to record over) into the VCR, and insert
the recorded tape into your camcorder.
(2) Prepare the VCR for recording, then set the input selector to LINE.
Connect the A/V connecting cable to the AUDIO/VIDEO jack. Refer to the
operating instructions of your VCR.
(3) Set the POWER switch to VCR on your camcorder.
(4) Play back the recorded tape on your camcorder.
(5) Start recording on the VCR.
Refer to the operating instructions of your VCR.
(1) Insert a blank tape (or a tape you want to record over) into the VCR, and insert
the recorded tape into your camcorder.
(2) Set the input selector on the VCR to DV IN if it is available. Refer to the
operating instructions of your VCR.
(3) Set the POWER switch to VCR on your camcorder.
(4) Play back the recorded tape on your camcorder.
(5) Start recording on the VCR.
Refer to the operating instructions of your VCR.
S VIDEO
AUDIO / VIDEO
IN
S VIDEO
VIDEO
AUDIO
VCR
DV
DV IN/OUT
DV IN/OUT
: Signal flow
(optional)
: Signal flow
S-VHSC,
Betamax,
70
71
Dubbing a tape
Note on tapes that are not recorded in the Digital8
The picture may fluctuate. This is not a malfunction.
You can duplicate selected scenes (programs) for editing onto a tape without operating
the VCR.
Scenes can be selected by frame. You can set up to 20 programs.
Your camcorder can dub on Memory Sticks (DCR-TRV340 only). See page 144 for
more information.
system
Unwanted scene
You can connect one VCR only using the i.LINK cable (DV connecting cable)
See page 189 for more information about i.LINK.
Unwanted scene
72
73
1-17
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
MENU
Step 2: Setting the VCR to operate with the A/V connecting cable
5 For DCR-TRV240:
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT READY
INDICATOR
RETURN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
1 IN
0:08:55:06
IR
Editing
To edit using the VCR, send the control signal by infrared rays to the remote sensor on
the VCR.
When you connect using an A/V connecting cable, follow the procedure below, steps
(1) to (4), to send the control signal correctly.
For DCR-TRV340:
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT RETURN
TAPE
INDICATOR
MEMORY
RETURN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
1 IN
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
IR
ADJ TEST
i. LINK
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
10
VIDEO EDIT
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
74
75
IR SETUP code
Brand
Sony
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6
IR SETUP code
Mitsubishi/MGA
Multitech
23, 32, 80
Aiwa
47, 54, 80
NEC
21, 33, 35
Akai
49, 51
Olympic
77, 78
Audio Dynamic
21, 35
Optimus
22
Bell&Howell
(M. Wards)
36
Orion
60
Broksonic
21, 70, 82
Pentax
8, 42
Canon
77, 78
Philco
Citizen
Panasonic
Philips
47, 73
Pioneer
Curtis Mathis
8, 77, 80
Quasar
Daewoo
26, 40, 77
RCA/PROSCAN
21, 33, 35
78
Dimensia
Realistic
Emerson
Sansui
21
Fisher
Singer
73
Funai
80
Samsung
General Electric
Sanyo
Goldstar/LG
47
Scott
GO VIDEO
71
Sharp
88, 89
Hitachi
Editing
47
Craig
DBX
1 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select PAUSEMODE, then press the dial.
2 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the mode to cancel recording pause
on the VCR, then press the dial.
Refer to the operating instructions of your VCR.
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE PAUSE
IR TEST
REC
RETURN
PB
[MENU] : END
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE PAUSE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
8, 42, 78
Shintom
73
HQ
40
Signature 2000
80, 89
Instant Replay
77, 78
Sylvania
(3) Setting your camcorder and the VCR to face each other
JC Penny
Symphonic
80
JVC
Tashiro
47
Kenwood
Tatung
21, 33, 35
LXI (Sears)
Teac
Locate the infrared rays emitter of your camcorder and face it towards the remote
sensor of the VCR.
Set the devices about 30 cm (12 in.) apart, and remove any obstacles between the
devices.
Magnavox
Technics
77, 78
Marantz
21, 33, 35
Toshiba
7, 40, 49
Marta
47
Wards
Memorex
37, 77
Yamaha
Minolta
8, 42
Zenith
95
VCR
Remote sensor
* TV/VCR component
Note on IR SETUP codes
Digital program editing is not possible if the VCR does not support IR SETUP codes.
76
77
1-18
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1 Insert a recordable tape into the VCR, then set to recording pause.
2 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select IR TEST, then press the dial.
3 Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select EXECUTE, then press the dial.
If the VCR starts recording, the setting is correct.
When recording is finished, the indicator changes to COMPLETE.
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
ENGAGE
IR SETUP
REC PAUSE
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
RETURN
EXECUTE
[MENU] : END
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
COMPLETE
RETURN
[MENU] : END
Editing
When you connect using i.LINK cable (DV connecting cable) (optional), follow the
procedure below.
78
79
MENU
5 For DCR-TRV240:
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
0:08:55:06
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT READY
INDICATOR
RETURN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
1 IN
IR
For DCR-TRV340:
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT RETURN
TAPE
INDICATOR
MEMORY
RETURN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
1 IN
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
IR
ADJ TEST
i. LINK
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
8
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
i. LINK
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
Editing
80
81
1-19
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3
VIDEO EDIT
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
RETURN
EXECUTE
ENGAGE
REC PAUSE
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
EXECUTING
CUTIN
CUTOUT
No. 5
IR SETUP
IN
PAUSEMODE 60
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
VIDEO EDIT
0:08:55:06
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
COMPLETE
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
VIDEO EDIT
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
VIDEO EDIT
EDIT SET
CONTROL
ADJ TEST
CUTIN
CUTOUT
IR SETUP
PAUSEMODE
IR TEST
RETURN
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
Editing
(1) Insert the tape for playback into your camcorder, and insert a tape for
recording into the VCR.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select
, then press the dial.
(4) For DCR-TRV240:
Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select VIDEO EDIT, then press the dial.
For DCR-TRV340:
Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select TAPE in VIDEO EDIT, then press the
dial.
(5) Search for the beginning of the first scene you want to insert using the video
operation buttons, then pause playback.
You can fine-adjust one frame at a time with EDITSEARCH.
(6) Press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial.
The IN point of the first program is set, and the top part of the program mark
changes to light blue.
(7) Search for the end of the first scene you want to insert using the video
operation buttons, then pause playback.
(8) Press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial.
The OUT point of the first program is set, then the bottom part of the program
mark changes to light blue.
(9) Repeat steps 5 to 8, then set the program.
When the program is set, the program mark changes to light blue.
You can set up to 20 programs.
Notes
When you complete step 3, the image used to adjust synchronization is recorded for
about 50 seconds.
If you start recording from the very beginning of the tape, the first few seconds of the
tape may not record properly. Be sure to allow about 10 seconds lead before starting
recording.
When you connect with an i.LINK cable (DV connecting cable) you may not be able to
operate the dubbing function correctly, depending on the VCR.
Keep the i.LINK connection, and set CONTROL to IR in the menu settings.
Video and audio signals are transmitted in digital format.
82
83
(1) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select UNDO, then press the dial.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select EXECUTE, then press the dial.
The last set program mark flashes, then the setting is canceled.
To cancel erasing
Select RETURN in step 2.
MENU
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
1 IN
0:08:55:06
1 IN
For DCR-TRV340:
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT RETURN
INDICATOR
TAPE
RETURN
MEMORY
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
TOTAL 0:00:00:00
SCENE 0
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
0:08:55:06
1 IN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
0:08:55:06
1 OUT
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
0:09:07:06
2 IN
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
EDIT SET
0:10:01:23
4 IN
TOTAL 0:00:12:00
SCENE 1
TOTAL 0:00:47:12
SCENE 3
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
Editing
OTHERS
DATA CODE
BEEP
COMMANDER
DISPLAY
VIDEO EDIT READY
INDICATOR
RETURN
For DCR-TRV240:
in the menu
84
85
1-20
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can capture images and sound from an analog video unit connected to your
computer which has the i.LINK (DV) jack connected to your camcorder.
Before operation
Set DISPLAY to LCD in the menu settings. (The default setting is LCD.)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Editing
AUDIO/VIDEO
VCR
OUT
S VIDEO
i.LINK
DV IN/OUT
VIDEO
You cannot record on the VCR when:
The cassette has run out of tape.
The write-protect tab on the cassette is set to lock.
The IR SETUP code is not correct (when IR is selected).
The button to cancel recording pause is not correct (when IR is selected).
AUDIO
(optional)
: Signal flow
Stop capturing procedures on your computer, and stop the playback on the analog
video unit.
Notes
You need to install software that supports the exchange video signals.
Depending on the state of the analog video signals, your computer may not be able to
output the images correctly when you convert analog video signals into digital video
signals via your camcorder. Depending on the analog video unit, the image may
contain noise or incorrect colors.
You cannot record or capture video output via your camcorder when the video tapes
include copyright protection signals such as the ID-2 system.
You can capture images and sound with an S video cable (optional) instead of the
A/V connecting cable (supplied).
If your computer has a USB jack
You can connect your camcorder to your computer using the USB cable supplied with
your camcorder. Note, however, that the image may flicker.
86
87
Notes
To enable smooth transition, we recommend that you do not mix pictures recorded in
the Hi8/standard 8 with the Digital8 system on a tape.
If you fast-forward or slow-playback on the other equipment, the image being
recorded may fluctuate. When recording from other equipment, be sure to play back
the original tape at normal speed.
You can record a tape from another VCR or a TV program from a TV that has video/
audio outputs. Use your camcorder as a recorder.
Before operation
Set DISPLAY to LCD in the menu settings. (The default setting is LCD.)
(1) Insert a blank tape (or a tape you want to record over) into your camcorder. If
you are recording a tape from the VCR, insert a recorded tape into the VCR.
(2) Set the POWER switch to VCR on your camcorder.
(3) Press z REC and the button on its right simultaneously on your camcorder,
then immediately press X on your camcorder.
(4) Press N on the VCR to start playback if you are recording a tape from VCR.
Select a TV program if you are recording from TV.
The picture from a TV or VCR appears on the screen of your camcorder.
(5) Press X on your camcorder at the scene where you want to start recording
from.
Editing
3
PAUSE
REC
OUT
S VIDEO
S VIDEO
VIDEO
VCR
AUDIO /
VIDEO
AUDIO
: Signal flow
88
89
1-21
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
You can insert a new scene from a VCR onto your originally recorded tape by
specifying the insert start and end points.
Use the Remote Commander for this operation.
Connections are the same as on page 88, 90. Insert a cassette containing the desired
scene to insert into the VCR.
Simply connect the i.LINK cable (DV connecting cable) (optional) to DV IN/OUT of
your camcorder and to DV OUT of the DV products. With a digital-to-digital
connection, video and audio signals are transmitted in digital form for high-quality
editing.
(1) Insert a blank tape (or a tape you want to record over) into your camcorder,
and insert the recorded tape into the VCR on your camcorder.
(2) Set the POWER switch to VCR on your camcorder.
(3) Press z REC and the button on its right simultaneously on your camcorder,
then immediately press X on your camcorder.
(4) Press N on the VCR to start playback.
The picture to be recorded appears on the screen of your camcorder.
(5) Press X on your camcorder at the scene where you want to start recording
from.
[a]
[A]
[b]
[c]
Editing
[B]
[C]
DV
DV IN/OUT
DV OUT
(optional)
: Signal flow
90
91
If you connect your camcorder and your computer using the USB cable, you can view
pictures live from your camcorder and pictures recorded on a tape on your computer
(USB Streaming function).
Furthermore, if you capture images recorded on a tape from your camcorder to your
computer, you can process or edit them in image processing software and append them
to e-mail.
5
REC
0:00:00
ZERO SET
MEMORY
ZERO SET
MEMORY
Editing
OS:
Microsoft Windows 98SE, Windows Me, Windows 2000 Professional, Windows XP
Home Edition or Windows XP Professional (standard installation)
However, operation is not assured if the above environment is an upgraded OS.
If you are using Windows 98, you cannot capture sounds.
CPU:
Minimum 500 MHz Intel Pentium III or faster (800 MHz or faster recommended)
Application:
DirectX 8.0a or later
Sound system:
16 bit stereo sound card and speakers
Memory:
64 MB or more
Hard disk:
Minimum 200 MB available hard disk space for installation
1 GB hard disk space or more recommended for working area (depending on the file
size of editing images)
Display:
4 MB VRAM video card, Minimum 800 600 dot Hi color (16 bit color, 65,000 colors),
Direct Draw display driver capability (At 800 600 dot or less, 256 colors and less, this
product will not operate correctly.)
Others:
This product is compatible with DirectX technology, so it is necessary to install DirectX.
The USB connector is provided as standard.
Press ZERO SET MEMORY again after step 5 to make the ZERO SET MEMORY
indicator disappear and begin from step 3.
Notes
The zero set memory function works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
Pictures and sound recorded on the section between the insert start and end points
will be erased when you insert the new scene.
When the inserted picture is played back
Pictures may be distorted at the end of the inserted section. This is not a malfunction.
To insert a scene without setting the insert end point
Skip step 3 and 4. Press x when you want to stop inserting.
92
93
1-22
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Notes
Operations are not guaranteed for either the Windows or Macintosh environment if
you connect two or more USB equipment to a single computer at the same time, or
when using a hub.
Some equipment may not operate depending on the type of USB equipment that is
used simultaneously.
Operations are not guaranteed for all the recommended computer environments
mentioned above.
Before connecting your camcorder to your computer, install the USB driver on the
computer. The USB driver is packaged together with application software for viewing
images on the CD-ROM supplied with your camcorder.
Start the following operation without connecting the USB cable to your
computer.
Connect the USB cable in step 8.
If the USB driver has been registered incorrectly because your computer was
connected to your camcorder before installation of the USB driver was complete,
reinstall the USB driver following the procedure on page 96.
Editing
For Windows 98SE, Windows Me, Windows 2000 Professional, Windows XP users
If you are using Windows 2000 Professional or Windows XP, log in with permission of
administrator.
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
94
95
(USB) jack
USB connector
(9) Follow the on-screen messages so that the Add Hardware Wizard recognizes
that the USB drivers have been installed. The Add Hardware Wizard starts
three times because three different USB drivers are installed. Be sure to allow
the installation to complete without interrupting it.
Editing
(10)Insert the supplied CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of your computer, then
select Browse t My computer t ImageMixer t sonyhcb.sys,
and click the OK button.
When the installation is complete, go to "Installing 'PIXELA ImageMixer Ver.1.0 for
Sony'" on page 99.
Windows 98SE
96
Windows Me
97
1-23
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Editing
6 Set the POWER switch to OFF (CHG) on your camcorder, and then disconnect
the USB cable.
7 Restart your computer.
Follow the directions on the screen to install DirectX. DirectX 8.0 will be installed.
98
99
(6) Click
on the screen.
To use this software in Windows 2000 Professional, you must be authorized as a Power
User or Administrator. For Windows XP, you must be authorized as an Administrator.
Viewing images
Viewing images recorded on a tape
The PIXELA ImageMixer Ver.1.0 for Sony startup screen appears on your
computer.
USB connector
(7) Click
Editing
(USB) jack
.
Preview window
USB cable
(3) Connect the AC power adaptor to your camcorder and then to a wall outlet,
and insert a cassette into your camcorder.
(4) Set the POWER switch to VCR.
Select USB STREAM to ON in
in the menu settings (p. 104).
(5) Select Start t Program t PIXELA t ImageMixer t ImageMixer
Ver.1.0 for Sony on Windows.
100
101
1-24
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Notes
When you view the image using your computer with USB connection, the image may
fluctuate.
When your camcorder is in the standby mode with a cassette inserted, it turns off
automatically after three minutes.
We recommend setting DEMO MODE to OFF in the menu settings when your
camcorder is in the standby mode, and no cassette is inserted.
Indicators in the camcorder LCD screen do not appear on images that are captured
into your computer.
(1) Follow the steps (1), (2) on page 100, then connect the AC power adaptor to
your camcorder and then to a wall outlet.
(2) Set the POWER switch to CAMERA.
in the menu settings (p. 104).
Select USB STREAM to ON in
(3) Follow the steps (5) to (7) on page 100, 101.
The image from your camcorder appears live in the preview window.
Capturing images
Preview window
(1) Click
PIXELA ImageMixer Ver.1.0 for Sony is provided with on-line help (operating
instructions).
(2) Click
at the point to capture using the preview window. The captured
image appears on the thumbnail list window.
(1) Click
button located in the upper-right corner of the screen.
The ImageMixers Manual screen appears.
(2) You can access the desired topics from the contents.
(1) Click
(2) Click
The
.
at the start point to capture using the preview window.
changes to
. Then click
Click
102
103
To change the mode settings in the menu settings, select the menu items with the SEL/
PUSH EXEC dial. The default settings can be partially changed. First, select the icon,
then the menu item and then the mode.
Press MENU.
Menu items are displayed as the following icons:
MANUAL SET
CAMERA SET
VCR SET
LCD/VF SET
MEMORY SET (DCR-TRV340 only)
PRINT SET (DCR-TRV340 only)
TAPE SET
SETUP MENU
OTHERS
For details, see Selecting the mode setting of each item (p. 105).
CAMERA
MANUAL SET
PROGRAM AE
P EFFECT
D EFFECT
FLASH MODE
FLASH LVL
N. S LIGHT
AUTO SHTR
MENU
[MENU] : END
VCR
2
TAPE SET
REC MODE
AUDIO MODE
REMAIN
TAPE SET
REC MODE SP
AUDIO MODE
REMAIN
RETURN
MANUAL SET
P EFFECT
D EFFECT
[MENU] : END
MEMORY
(DCR-TRV340 only)
POWER
switch
CAMERA
MEMORY
P EFFECT
CAMERA
VCR
D EFFECT
CAMERA
VCR
CAMERA
MEMORY
Mode
FLASH MODE
3
TAPE SET
REC MODE
AUDIO MODE
AUTO
REMAIN
RETURN
TAPE SET
REC MODE
AUDIO MODE
REMAIN
AUTO
RETURN
ON
FLASH LVL
z ON
AUTO
AUTO
HIGH
z NORMAL
MANUAL SET
PROGRAM AE
FLASH MODE
FLASH LVL
N. S LIGHT
AUTO SHTR
[MENU] : END
Meaning
PROGRAM AE
Icon/item
LOW
N.S. LIGHT
OFF
4
TAPE SET
REC MODE
AUDIO MODE
REMAIN
AUTO
RETURN
ON
z ON
AUTO SHTR
TAPE SET
REC MODE
AUDIO MODE
ON
REMAIN
RETURN
z ON
OFF
Normal setting
CAMERA
MEMORY
CAMERA
MEMORY
CAMERA
MEMORY
104
105
1-25
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Icon/item
Mode
Meaning
SELFTIMER*
z OFF
D ZOOM
z OFF
ON
PHOTO REC*
z MEMORY
z OFF
z ON
z OFF
TBC*
Meaning
z STEREO
z ON
z ON
VCR
OFF
CAMERA
MEMORY
ST1
ON
CAMERA
PB MODE
z AUTO
* DCR-TRV340 only
Notes on the SteadyShot function
The SteadyShot function will not correct excessive camera-shake.
Attachment of a conversion lens (optional) may influence the SteadyShot function.
VCR
ST2
VCR
VCR
To correct jitter
OFF
POWER
switch
Mode
CAMERA
CAMERA
ON
SET
HiFi SOUND
ON
z OFF
Icon/item
VCR
INT. REC
CAMERA
MEMORY
700
OFF
FRAME REC
ON
STEADYSHOT
50
TAPE
16:9WIDE
POWER
switch
CAMERA
MEMORY
VCR
* When you play back tapes recorded in the Hi8/standard 8 system only
Notes on AUDIO MIX
When playing back a tape recorded in the 16-bit mode, you cannot adjust the balance.
You can adjust the balance only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
Note on PB MODE
The mode will return to the default setting when:
you remove the battery pack or power source.
you turn the POWER switch.
(continued on the following page)
106
107
Icon/item
Mode
LCD BRIGHT
To darken
LCD B. L.
LCD COLOR
POWER
switch
Meaning
Icon/item
*
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
PIC MODE
QUALITY
BRIGHT
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
Meaning
POWER
switch
z SINGLE
MEMORY
MULTI SCRN
To lighten
Mode
STILL SET
z FINE
STANDARD
FLD/FRAME
z FIELD
VCR
MEMORY
FRAME
z 320 240
160 112
MEMORY
MOVIE SET
VF B.L.
To get highintensity
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
REMAIN
PRINT MARK
z AUTO
ON
ON
z OFF
PROTECT
ON
z OFF
VCR
MEMORY
VCR
MEMORY
VCR
MEMORY
VCR
MEMORY
SLIDE SHOW
MEMORY
PHOTO SAVE
VCR
VCR
MEMORY
FILE NO.
z SERIES
RESET
IMAGESIZE
To get lowintensity
* DCR-TRV340 only
(continued on the following page)
108
109
1-26
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Icon/item
Mode
Meaning
POWER
switch
DELETE ALL
z RETURN
MEMORY
FORMAT
z RETURN
OK
OK
9PIC PRINT
Meaning
z SP
AUDIO MODE
z 12BIT
LP
MEMORY
SAME
MULTI
MARKED
z OFF
Mode
REC MODE
DATE
DAY&TIME
16BIT
q REMAIN
z AUTO
MEMORY
MEMORY
ON
POWER
switch
CAMERA
VCR
CAMERA
VCR*
CAMERA
VCR
Notes on formatting *
Supplied Memory Sticks have been formatted at factory. Formatting Memory
Sticks on your camcorder is not required.
Do not turn the POWER switch or press any button while the display shows
FORMATTING.
You cannot format the Memory Stick if the write-protect tab on the Memory Stick
is set to LOCK.
Format the Memory Stick when FORMAT ERROR is displayed.
DATE/TIME
z RETURN
Icon/item
110
111
Icon/item
Mode
CLOCK SET
USB STREAM
z OFF
LTR SIZE
z NORMAL
LANGUAGE
z ENGLISH
ON
2
Meaning
CAMERA
MEMORY
CAMERA
VCR
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
Icon/item
DATA CODE
WORLD TIME
BEEP
Mode
Meaning
z DATE/CAM
CAMERA
MEMORY
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
z MELODY
ESPAOL
NORMAL
PORTUGUS
OFF
z ON
DEMO MODE
z ON
OFF
CAMERA
DISPLAY
z LCD
V-OUT/LCD
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
MEMORY
DATE
FRANAIS
COMMANDER
POWER
switch
VCR
Note
If you press DISPLAY with DISPLAY set to V-OUT/LCD in the menu settings, the
picture from a TV or VCR will not appear on the screen even when your camcorder is
connected to outputs on the TV or VCR. (Except when your camcorder is connected
with the i.LINK cable)
In more than five minutes after removing the power source
The AUDIO MIX, FLASH LVL, COMMANDER and HiFi SOUND settings are returned
to their default settings.
Other menu settings are held in memory even when the battery is removed.
(continued on the following page)
112
113
1-27
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Mode
Meaning
POWER
switch
REC LAMP
z ON
CAMERA
MEMORY
VIDEO EDIT
z RETURN*
Icon/item
OFF
INDICATOR
DCR-TRV340 only
You can record and play back images on a Memory Stick supplied with your
camcorder. You can easily play back, record or delete images. You can exchange image
data with other equipment such as your computer etc., using the USB cable for
Memory Stick supplied with your camcorder.
TAPE*
MEMORY*
z BL OFF
BL ON
On file format
VCR
CAMERA
VCR
MEMORY
* DCR-TRV340 only
Notes on INDICATOR
When you select BL ON, battery life is reduced by about 10 percent during recording.
When you use power sources other than the battery pack, BL ON is automatically
selected.
Write-protect tab
Labeling position
Moving picture
MOV00001:
This file name appears on the screen of your camcorder.
Mov00001.mpg: This file name appears on the display of your computer.
You cannot record or erase images when the write-protect tab on the Memory Stick
is set to LOCK.
The position and shape of the write-protect tab may be different depending on the
model.
We recommend backing up important data on the hard disk of your computer.
Image data may be damaged in the following cases:
If you remove the Memory Stick or turn the power off during reading or writing.
If you use Memory Sticks near static electricity or magnetic fields.
Prevent metallic objects or your finger from coming into contact with the metal parts
of the terminal.
Stick the label at the labeling position.
Do not bend, drop or apply strong shock to Memory Sticks.
Do not disassemble or modify Memory Sticks.
Do not let Memory Sticks become wet.
Do not use or keep Memory Sticks in locations that are:
Extremely hot such as in a car parked in the sun or under the scorching sun
Under direct sunlight
Very humid or subject to corrosive gases
When you carry or store a Memory Stick, put it in its case.
114
115
Insert a Memory Stick in the Memory Stick slot as far as it can go with the b mark
facing toward the Memory Stick slot as illustrated.
Access lamp
b mark
If
MEMORY STICK ERROR is displayed
Reinsert Memory Stick a few times. The Memory Stick may be damaged if the
indicator is still displayed. If this occurs, use another Memory Stick.
116
117
1-28
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Setting
Meaning
FINE (FINE)
(1) Set the POWER switch to VCR or MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select STILL SET in
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select QUALITY, then press the dial.
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired image quality, then press
the dial.
STANDARD (STD)
Memory capacity
FINE
About 100 KB
STANDARD
About 60 KB
You can select the image quality mode in still image recording. The default setting is
FINE.
PO
WE
R
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE SINGLE
QUALITY
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
EM
A
ER ORY
[MENU] : END
CA
M
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE
FINE
QUALITY
FLD/FRAME STANDARD
RETURN
REMAIN
40
[MENU] : END
MENU
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE
STANDARD
QUALITY
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
REMAIN
60
[MENU] : END
Note
In some cases, changing the image quality mode may not affect the image quality,
depending on the type of images you are shooting.
118
119
The number of images you can record varies depending on which image quality you
select and the complexity of the subject.
(1) Set the POWER switch to VCR or MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select MOVIE SET in
dial.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select IMAGESIZE, then press the dial.
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired image size, then press the
dial.
The indicator changes as follows:
320
Image
quality
16MB
(optional)
32MB
(optional)
64MB
(optional)
128MB
(optional)
FINE
80 images
160 images
325 images
650 images
1310 images
STANDARD
120 images
240 images
485 images
980 images
1970 images
160
Image size
8MB
(supplied)
16MB
(optional)
32MB
(optional)
64MB
(optional)
128MB
(optional)
160 112
5 min.
20 sec.
10 min.
40 sec.
21min.
20 sec.
42min.
40 sec.
85min.
20 sec.
320 240
1 min.
20 sec.
2 min.
40 sec.
5 min.
20 sec.
10min.
40 sec.
21min.
20 sec.
PO
WE
R
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
CA
M
EM
A
ER ORY
REMAIN
40sec
The table above shows approximate number of still images and times of moving
pictures you can record on a Memory Stick formatted on your camcorder.
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
MOVIE SET
IMAGESIZE 160 112
REMAIN
RETURN
[MENU] : END
REMAIN
2 min
MENU
Meaning
320 240
160 112
Indicator (Recording/Playback)
320
160
320 240
15 seconds
160 112
60 seconds
120
121
1-29
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
Notes
When recording fast-moving subjects in the FRAME mode, the recorded image blurry.
When recording in the FRAME mode, your camcorder may not correct camera-shake.
We recommend that you shoot objects with a tripod.
When recording still images at step 2 with PHOTO pressed lightly, the image
momentarily flickers. This is not a malfunction.
You can select the FIELD or FRAME mode in still image recording. Your camcorder
compensates for camera-shake when recording moving subjects in the FIELD mode.
Your camcorder records still images in high quality in the FRAME mode. Select the
FIELD or FRAME in the menu settings (p. 104).
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Keep pressing PHOTO lightly until the desired still image appears. The green
z mark stops flashing, then lights up. The brightness of the image and focus
are adjusted, being targeted for the middle of the image and are fixed.
Recording does not start yet.
(3) Press PHOTO deeper.
Recording is complete when the bar scroll indicator disappears.
The image when you pressed PHOTO deeper will be recorded on the
Memory Stick.
[a][b]
STD
1 / 12
PHOTO
Recording data
The recording data (date/time or various settings when recorded) are not displayed
while recording. However, they are recorded automatically onto the Memory Stick.
To display the recording data, press DATA CODE on the Remote Commander during
playback.
STD
PHOTO
1
WE
G)
F(CH
OF
CR
V
PO
Set PHOTO REC to MEMORY in the menu settings before operation. (The default
setting is MEMORY.)
Press PHOTO to record still images on Memory Sticks in CAMERA mode, while you
are standing by for recording or recording moving pictures to tape.
CA
M
You cannot record still images on Memory Sticks in CAMERA mode in the
following functions:
Fader
Wide mode
Super NightShot
Color Slow Shutter
Picture effects
Digital effects
MEMORY MIX
EM
A
ER ORY
122
123
PHOTO
MULTI SCRN
Your camcorder shoots nine still images at about 0.4 sec intervals and displays the
)
images on a single page divided into nine boxes. (
2,6
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
3
MENU
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE SINGLE
QUALITY
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE SINGLE
QUALITY
MULTI SCRN
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE MULTI SCRN
QUALITY
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
PIC MODE SINGLE
QUALITY
MULTI SCRN
FLD/FRAME
RETURN
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the dial.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select STILL SET in
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select PIC MODE, then press the dial.
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired setting, then press the
dial.
(6) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
(7) Press PHOTO deeper.
124
125
1-30
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
You can superimpose a still image you have recorded on the Memory Stick on the
moving picture you are recording. You can record the superimposed images on a tape
or a Memory Stick. (However, you can record only superimposed still images on the
Memory Stick.)
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) In the standby mode, press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select SELFTIMER in
dial.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(5) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear.
(6) Press PHOTO deeper.
Self-timer starts counting down from 10 with a beep. In the last two seconds of
the countdown, the beep gets faster, then recording starts automatically.
PHOTO
PHOTO
Still image
CAMERA SET
OFF
SELFTIMER
ON
D ZOOM
STEADYSHOT
RETURN
Moving picture
M. CHROM
[MENU] : END
Blue
MENU
Still image
Moving picture
Still image
Moving picture
M. LUMI
Note
The self-timer recording mode is automatically canceled when:
Self-timer recording is finished.
The POWER switch is set to OFF (CHG) or VCR.
Blue
Still image
Moving picture
M. OVERLAP*
* The superimposed image using Memory overlap function can be recorded on tapes
only.
126
127
Before operation
Insert a tape for recording into your camcorder.
Insert a Memory Stick is recorded still images into your camcorder.
M. CHROM
The color (blue) scheme of the area in the still image which is
to be swapped with a moving picture
M. LUMI
The color (bright) scheme of the area in the still image which
is to be swapped with a moving picture
C. CHROM The color (blue) scheme of the area in the moving picture
which is to be swapped with a still image
M. OVERLAP No adjustment necessary
During recording
You cannot change the mode setting.
To record the superimposed image as a still image
Press PHOTO deeper in step 7.
The fewer bars there are on the screen, the stronger the effect becomes.
2
MEMORY
MIX
M. LUMI
M. LUMI I I I
M. LUMI I
M. CHROM
1000021
1000021
Still image
1000021
1000021
128
129
1-31
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2
MEMORY
MIX
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick is recorded still images into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MEMORY MIX.
The last recorded or last composed image appears on the lower part of the
screen as a thumbnail image.
(3) Press MEMORY+/ to select the still image you want to superimpose.
To see the previous image, press MEMORY . To see the next image, press
MEMORY+.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select the desired mode.
The mode changes as follows:
M. CHROM y M. LUMI y C. CHROM
(5) Press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial.
The still image is superimposed on the moving picture.
(6) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to adjust the effect.
M. LUMI
C. CHROM
M. LUMI
M. LUMI I I I
M. LUMI I
1000021
1000021
Still image
1000021
1000021
The color (blue) scheme of the area in the still image which is
to be swapped with a moving picture
The color (bright) scheme of the area in the still image which
is to be swapped with a moving picture
The color (blue) scheme of the area in the moving picture
which is to be swapped with a still image
M. CHROM
4
M. CHROM
The fewer bars there are on the screen, the stronger the effect becomes.
Press the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial before step 7, and repeat the procedure from step 4.
130
131
DCR-TRV340 only
Notes
You cannot use the MEMORY MIX function for moving pictures recorded on
Memory Sticks.
When the overlapping still image has a large amount of white, the thumbnail image of
the picture may not be clear.
Your camcorder can read moving image data recorded on a tape recorded in the
Digital8 system, and record it as a still image on a Memory Stick.
Your camcorder can also capture moving image data through the input connector and
record it as a still image on a Memory Stick.
Before operation
Insert a tape recorded in the Digital8 system into your camcorder.
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
During recording
You cannot change the mode setting.
Sample images
Sample images stored in the Memory Stick supplied with your camcorder are
protected (p. 168).
REW
PLAY
FF
CAPTURE
PHOTO
The Memory Stick supplied with your camcorder is already stored with 20
images
For M. CHROM: 18 images (such as a frame) 100-0001~100-0018
For C. CHROM: two images (such as a background) 100-0019~100-0020
PHOTO
When recording images on a Memory Stick using the MEMORY MIX function
The PROGRAM AE function does not work. (The indicator flashes.)
132
133
1-32
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DV
DV OUT
DV IN/OUT
(optional)
: Signal flow
Note
REC ERROR is displayed and recording is not possible.
In the following instances,
Record undistorted images.
When recording on a tape in a poor recording state, for example, on a tape that has
been repeatedly used for dubbing
Between scenes or in the various playback modes on the tape recorded in Hi8/
standard 8 system
When attempting to input images that are distorted due to poor radio wave reception
when a TV tuner unit is in use
OUT
S VIDEO
VCR
Before operation
Set DISPLAY to LCD in the menu settings. (The default setting is LCD.)
S VIDEO
VIDEO
AUDIO /
VIDEO
: Signal flow
Connect the yellow plug of the A/V connecting cable to the video jack on the VCR or
the TV.
If your TV or VCR has an S video jack
Pictures can be reproduced more faithfully by using an S video cable (optional).
With this connection, you do not need to connect the yellow (video) plug of the A/V
connecting cable.
Connect an S video cable (optional) to the S video jacks of both your camcorder and the
TV or VCR.
134
135
DCR-TRV340 only
To stop copying
Using the search function, you can automatically capture only still images from tapes
recorded in the Digital8 system and record them on a Memory Stick in sequence.
Press MENU.
Before operation
Insert a tape recorded in the Digital8 system and rewind the tape.
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
MEMORY FULL appears on the screen, and copying stops. Insert another Memory
Stick and repeat the procedure from step 2.
PHOTO
3
MENU
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
PHOTO SAVE READY
FILE NO.
RETURN
[MENU] : END
0:30:00:00
25/40
FINE
21/40
FINE
SAV I NG
0
END
4
[MENU] : END
[MENU] : END
PHOTO SAVE
PHOTO SAVE
PHOTO SAVE
0:00:00:00
21/40
FINE
PHOTO BUTTON
[PHOTO] : START [MENU] : END
136
137
1-33
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press START/STOP. Your camcorder starts recording. The camera recording
lamp located on the front of your camcorder lights up. When IMAGESIZE in
the menu settings is set to 320 240, the maximum recording time is 15
seconds. However, when IMAGESIZE in the menu settings is set to 160 112,
the maximum recording time is 60 seconds.
Recording date/time
The date/time are not displayed while recording. However, they are automatically
recorded onto the Memory Stick.
To display the recording date/time, press DATA CODE on the Remote Commander
during playback. Various settings cannot be recorded.
During recording on Memory Stick
Do not eject the cassette tape from your camcorder. During ejecting the tape, sound is
not recorded on the Memory Stick.
50min
320 REC
0:03
[15sec]
[a]
BBB
[b]
To stop recording
Press START/STOP.
Note
Sound is recorded in monaural.
When the POWER switch is set to MEMORY
The following functions do not work:
Wide mode
SUPER NIGHTSHOT
Color Slow Shutter
Fader
Picture effects
Digital effects
Titles
138
139
DCR-TRV340 only
Notes
Sound recorded in 48 kHz is converted to 32 kHz sound when recording pictures from
a tape to Memory Sticks.
Sound recorded in stereo is converted to monaural sound when recording from tape.
Your camcorder can read moving picture data recorded on tapes and record it as a
moving picture on a Memory Stick. Your camcorder can also capture moving picture
data through the input connector and record it as a moving picture on a Memory
Stick.
Before operation
Insert a recorded tape into your camcorder.
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
If
AUDIO ERROR is displayed
Sound that cannot be recorded by your camcorder has been recorded. Connect the A/V
connecting cable to input images from external equipment used to play back the image
(p. 142).
PLAY
PAUSE
50min
0:15:42:43
320REC0:03
[15sec]
[a]
BBB
[b]
Recording date/time
The recording data (date/time) when it is recorded on Memory Stick is recorded.
Various settings are not recorded.
To stop recording
Press START/STOP or x.
140
141
1-34
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DV
DV OUT
(optional)
DV IN/OUT
: Signal flow
Note
In the following instances, recording is discontinued.
When recording on a tape in a poor recording state, for example, on a tape that has
been repeatedly used for dubbing
Between scenes or in the various playback modes on the tape recorded in Hi8/
standard 8 system
When attempting to input images that are distorted due to poor radio wave reception
when a TV tuner unit is in use
The recording stops automatically if the picture is disrupted.
When the input signal is cut off
OUT
S VIDEO
VIDEO
VCR
AUDIO
AUDIO/
VIDEO
S VIDEO
: Signal flow
Connect the yellow plug of the A/V connecting cable to the video jack on the VCR or
the TV.
142
143
7,9
DCR-TRV340 only
You can duplicate selected scenes (programs) for editing onto Memory Sticks.
STOP
REW
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
FF
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
IMAGE SIZE
0:08:55:06
1 OUT
0 SEC [
TOTAL
320
15SEC]
[MENU] : END
10
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
IMAGE SIZE
0:08:55:06
2 IN
3 SEC [
TOTAL
320
15SEC]
[MENU] : END
11
VIDEO EDIT
MARK
UNDO
ERASE ALL
START
IMAGE SIZE
TOTAL
0:10:01:23
4 IN
13 SEC [
320
15SEC]
[MENU] : END
MENU
(1) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC to select UNDO, then press the dial.
(2) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC to select EXECUTE, then press the dial.
To cancel erasing
Select RETURN in step 2.
144
145
1-35
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Notes
Digital program editing works only for tapes recorded in the Digital8 system.
You cannot dub the titles or display indicators.
You cannot operate recording during Digital program editing on Memory Sticks.
You cannot set IN or OUT on a blank portion of the tape.
If there is a blank portion between IN and OUT on the tape, the total time code may
not be displayed correctly.
(1) Select VIDEO EDIT in the menu settings. Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to
select MEMORY, then press the dial.
(2) Select START in the menu settings. Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select
EXECUTE, then press the dial.
Search for the beginning of the first program, then start dubbing.
The program mark flashes.
The SEARCH indicator appears during search, the EDITING indicator appears
during writing of data on your camcorder, and REC appears during dubbing
on the screen.
The program mark changes to light blue after dubbing is complete.
When the dubbing ends, your camcorder automatically stops.
146
147
DCR-TRV340 only
You can play back still images recorded on a Memory Stick. You can also play back
six images including moving pictures in order at a time by selecting the index screen.
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MEMORY PLAY. The last recorded image is displayed.
(3) Press MEMORY +/ to select the desired still image. To see the previous
image, press MEMORY . To see the next image, press MEMORY +.
PLAY
21 / 40
MEMORY PLAY
Protect
JUL 4 2002
12:05:56 PM
Recording data
Print mark
Recording data
You can view recording data (date/time or various settings when recorded) by pressing
DATA CODE on the Remote Commander.
148
149
1-36
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
You can play back moving pictures recorded on a Memory Stick. You can also play
back six images including still images in order at a time by selecting the index screen.
You can play back six recorded images at a time. This function is especially useful when
searching for a particular image.
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MEMORY INDEX to display the index screen.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MEMORY PLAY. The last recorded image is displayed.
(3) Press MEMORY +/ to select the desired moving pictures. To see the previous
picture, press MEMORY . To see the next picture, press MEMORY +.
(4) Press MPEG N X to start playback.
2
INDEX
PLAY
4
MPEG
A red B mark appears above the image that is displayed before changing to the index
screen mode.
B mark
100-0006
6 / 40
Press MPEG N X .
Note
You may not be able to play back images with your camcorder:
When playing back image data modified on your computer.
When playing back image data shot with other equipment.
Note
When displaying the index screen, the number appears above each image. This
indicates the order in which images are recorded on the Memory Stick. These
numbers are different from the data file names (p. 115).
150
151
DCR-TRV340 only
You can view data recorded on the Memory Stick on your computer.
Note
Data recorded on the Memory Stick is stored in the following formats. Make sure that
applications that support these file formats are installed on your computer.
Still images:
JPEG format
Moving pictures/audio: MPEG format
Image size
MOV00001
320
2 / 20
MEMORY PLAY
0:12
JUL 4 2002
12:05:56 PM
Protect
Recording date/time
You can view recording date/time by pressing DATA CODE on the Remote
Commander during playback.
152
Notes
Operations are not guaranteed for either the Windows or Macintosh environment if
you connect two or more USB equipment to a single computer at the same time, or
when using a hub.
Some equipment may not operate depending on the type of USB equipment that is
used simultaneously.
Operations are not guaranteed for all the recommended computer environments
mentioned above.
All other product names mentioned herein may be the trademarks or registered
trademarks of their respective companies. Furthermore, and are not
mentioned in each case in this manual.
Recording date/time.
(Various settings are displayed as .)
153
1-37
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Before connecting your camcorder to your computer, install the USB driver on the
computer. The USB driver is packaged together with application software for viewing
images on the CD-ROM supplied with your camcorder.
If you installed the USB driver in Viewing images recorded on tape on your computer
(p. 95), start from step 5.
For Windows XP users
The USB driver needs not be installed. Your computer is automatically recognized as a
driver just by connecting your computer using the USB cable.
For Windows 98/98SE/Me, Windows 2000 Professional users
If you are using Windows 2000 Professional, log in with permission of administrator.
(USB) jack
Start the following operation without connecting the USB cable to your
computer.
Connect the USB cable in step 6.
USB connector
If the USB driver has been registered incorrectly because your computer was
connected to your camcorder before installation of the USB driver was completed.
Reinstall the USB driver following the procedure on page 156.
(1) Turn on the power of your computer and allow Windows to load.
(2) Insert the supplied CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive of your computer. The
application software screen appears.
USB cable
Note
You cannot install the USB driver if a Memory Stick is not in your camcorder.
Be sure to insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder before installing the USB
driver.
154
155
The USB driver has been registered incorrectly as your computer was connected to your
camcorder before installation of the USB driver was completed. Perform the following
procedure to correctly install the USB driver.
An application such as Windows Media Player must be installed to play back moving
pictures in Windows environment.
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
(USB) jack
USB connector
USB cable
Still image
Dcim folder
Moving picture*
* Copying a file to the hard disk of your computer before viewing it is recommended. If
you play back the file directly from the Memory Stick, the image and sound may
break off.
(1) Move the cursor to the Unplug or Eject Hardware icon on the Task Tray and
click to cancel the applicable drive.
(2) A message to remove the device from the system appears, then unplug the
USB cable or eject the Memory Stick.
(3) Set the POWER switch of your camcorder to OFF(CHG).
156
157
1-38
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
158
(4) Select all six files, and drag and drop them into the System Folder.
(5) When the message appears, click OK.
(6) Restart your computer.
159
QuickTime 3.0 or newer must be installed to play back moving pictures in Macintosh
environment.
Memory Stick
Memory Stick operations on your camcorder cannot be assured if a Memory Stick
formatted on your computer is used on your camcorder, or if the Memory Stick in
your camcorder was formatted from your computer when the USB cable was
connected.
Do not compress the data on the Memory Stick. Compressed files cannot be played
back on your camcorder.
Software
Depending on your application software, the file size may increase when you open a
still image file.
When you load an image modified using retouching software from your computer to
your camcorder or when you directly modify the image on your camcorder, the image
format will differ so a file error indicator may appear and you may be unable to open
the file.
Dcim folder
Moving picture*
* Copying a file to the hard disk of your computer before viewing it is recommended. If
you play back the file directly from the Memory Stick, the image and sound may
break off.
Still image
Folder
160
File
Meaning
100MSDCF
DSC0ssss.JPG
MOML0001
MOV0ssss.MPG
161
1-39
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
During copying
You cannot operate the following buttons:
MEMORY PLAY
MEMORY INDEX
MEMORY DELETE
MEMORY MIX
MEMORY +/
You can copy still images recorded on Memory Sticks and record them to tapes.
Before operation
Insert a tape for recording into your camcorder.
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
3
REC
PLAY
PAUSE
To stop copying
Press x.
162
163
DCR-TRV340 only
You can enlarge still images recorded on a Memory Stick. You can select and view a
desired part from the enlarged still image. Also, you can copy the desired part of the
enlarged still image to tapes or Memory Sticks.
Press PB ZOOM.
The PB ZOOM mode is canceled when the following buttons are pressed:
MENU
MEMORY PLAY
MEMORY INDEX
MEMORY +/
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press PB ZOOM on your camcorder while you are playing back images
recorded on Memory Stick. The still image is enlarged, and R r indicators
showing the direction to move the image appear on the screen.
(3) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to move the enlarged image, then press the dial.
R : The image moves downward.
r : The image moves upward.
T t becomes available.
(4) Turn SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to move the enlarged image, then press the dial.
T : The image moves rightward. (Turn the dial downward.)
t : The image moves leftward. (Turn the dial upward.)
(5) Adjust the zoom ratio by the power zoom lever.
You can enlarge the image from 1.1 times up to five times its size.
W : Decreases the zoom ratio.
T : Increase the zoom ratio.
2
PB ZOOM
PB ZOOM
5.0
[EXEC] : T t
PB ZOOM
5.0
[EXEC] : r R
164
165
1-40
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
You can automatically play back images in sequence. This function is useful especially
when checking recorded images or during a presentation.
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select SLIDE SHOW in
dial.
(4) Press MEMORY PLAY. Your camcorder plays back the images recorded on the
Memory Stick in sequence.
2
Memory Stick operations
MENU
3
4
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW READY
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
PLAY
SLIDE SHOW
100 0021
21/40
166
167
DCR-TRV340 only
DCR-TRV340 only
You can protect selected images, to prevent accidental erasure of important images.
You can delete images stored in a Memory Stick. You can delete all images or only
selected images.
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Play back the image you want to protect.
(3) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the dial.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select PROTECT in
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(6) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear. The - mark is displayed
beside the data file name of the protected image.
3,6
5
MENU
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Play back the image you want to delete.
(3) Press MEMORY DELETE. DELETE? appears on the screen.
(4) Press MEMORY DELETE again. The selected image is deleted.
3
21/40
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
OFF
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
21/40
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
ON
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW OFF
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
21/40
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
ON
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW OFF
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
ON
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
DELETE
1000021
DELETE
21/40
DELETE?
[DELETE] : DEL
[] : CANCEL
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
21/40
168
169
1-41
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY. Make sure that the LOCK switch is set to
the left (unlock) position.
(2) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
(3) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select DELETE ALL in
, then press the
dial.
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select OK, then press the dial. OK changes
to EXECUTE.
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select EXECUTE, then press the dial.
DELETING appears on the screen. When all unprotected images are deleted,
COMPLETE is displayed.
4
MENU
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL READY
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL RETURN
OK
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL RETURN
OK
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL RETURN
EXECUTE
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL DELETING
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL COMPLETE
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
170
171
DCR-TRV340 only
You can specify a recorded still image to print out by writing a print mark. This
function is useful for printing out still images later.
Your camcorder conforms to the DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) standard for
specifying still images to print out.
Moving pictures
You cannot write print marks on moving pictures.
Before operation
Insert a Memory Stick into your camcorder.
(1) Set the POWER switch to MEMORY or VCR. Make sure that the LOCK switch
is set to the left (unlock) position.
(2) Play back the still image you want to write a print mark on.
(3) Press MENU to display the menu settings.
, then press the
(4) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select PRINT MARK in
dial.
(5) Turn the SEL/PUSH EXEC dial to select ON, then press the dial.
(6) Press MENU to make the menu settings disappear. The
mark is displayed
beside the data file name of the image with a print mark.
3,6
5
MENU
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK OFF
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK ON
PROTECT
OFF
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK ON
PROTECT
OFF
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
MEMORY SET
STILL SET
MOVIE SET
PRINT MARK ON
PROTECT
SLIDE SHOW
FILE NO.
DELETE ALL
FORMAT
RETURN
[MENU] : END
172
173
1-42
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV340 only
You can use the printer (optional) on your camcorder to print images on print paper.
For details, refer to the operating instructions of the printer.
There are various ways of printing still images. The following, however, describes how
in the menu settings on your camcorder. (p. 104)
to print by selecting
Before operation
Insert a recorded Memory Stick into your camcorder.
Attach the optional printer to your camcorder.
Printer
9PIC PRINT
PRINT SET
9PIC PRINT
DATE/TIME
RETURN
DATE/TIME
PRINT SET
9PIC PRINT
DATE/TIME
RETURN
RETURN
SAME
MULTI
MARKED
[MENU] : END
DATE
OFF
DATE
DAY&TIME
[MENU] : END
MENU
You can print nine still images on the 9-split print paper. Select the desired mode in the
menu settings.
SAME PICS
JUL
4 2002
4 12:00 PM
174
175
Troubleshooting
If you run into any problem using your camcorder, use the following table to
troubleshoot the problem. If the problem persists, disconnect the power source and
contact your Sony dealer or local authorized Sony service facility. If C:ss:ss
appears on the screen or the display window, the self-diagnosis display function has
worked. See page 182.
Troubleshooting
176
1-43
177
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Symptom
The Memory Stick does not
function.
178
Troubleshooting
179
Others
Others
Symptom
Symptom
Troubleshooting
180
181
1-44
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Self-diagnosis display
Your camcorder has a self-diagnosis display
function.
This function displays the current state of your
camcorder as a 5-digit code (a combination of a
letter and figures) on the screen or in the display
window.
If a 5-digit code is displayed, check the following
list of codes. The last two digits (indicated by ss)
differ depending on the state of your camcorder.
Warning indicators
1000001
C:21:00
Self-diagnosis display
C:ss:ss
You can service your camcorder
yourself.
E:ss:ss
Contact your Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony facility.
Five-digit display
C:04:ss
C:22:ss
C:31:ss
C:32:ss
E:20:ss
E:61:ss
E:62:ss
If you are unable to rectify the problem even if you try corrective actions a few times,
contact your Sony dealer or local authorized Sony service facility.
Troubleshooting
C:21:ss
182
183
Additional Information
FOR InfoLITHIUM
BATTERY ONLY
This video system has been developed to enable digital recording to Hi8
video cassette.
Q Z TAPE END
Q NO TAPE
CLEANING CASSETTE
COPY INHIBIT
FULL**
-**
NO FILE**
NO MEMORY STICK**
AUDIO ERROR**
MEMORY STICK ERROR** The Memory Stick data is corrupted* (p. 117).
FORMAT ERROR**
- DIRECTORY ERROR** The Memory Stick has more than one directory
PLAY ERROR**
REC ERROR**
NO PRINT MARK**
Playback system
The Digital8 system or Hi8
/standard 8 system is automatically detected
before the tape is played back.
During playback of tapes recorded in the Hi8
/standard 8 system, digital signals
are output as the image signals from the DV IN/OUT jack.
t
/
FORMATTING**
NOW CHARGING
DELETING**
/standard 8
is a trademark.
is a trademark.
is a trademark.
/Digital8
Additional Information
Note
Tapes recorded in the Digital8
(analog) system machine.
system?
Copyright signal
When you play back
Using any other video camera recorder, you cannot record on a tape that has recorded
copyright control signals for copyright protection of software which is played back on
your camcorder.
184
185
1-45
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Digital8
The InfoLITHIUM battery pack is a lithium-ion battery pack that has functions for
communicating information related to operating conditions between your camcorder
and an AC adaptor/charger (optional).
The InfoLITHIUM battery pack calculates the power consumption according to the
operating conditions of your camcorder, and displays the remaining battery time in
minutes.
system
When you play back a Digital8 system tape which is dubbed from a dual sound track
tape recorded in the DV system, set HiFi SOUND to the desired mode in the menu
settings (p. 104).
Sound from speaker
HiFi Sound
Playing back
Mode
a stereo tape
STEREO
Stereo
1
Lch
2
Rch
Be sure to charge the battery pack before you start using your camcorder.
We recommend charging the battery pack in an ambient temperature of between
10C to 30C (50F to 86F) until the backlight of the display window goes out,
indicating that the battery pack is fully charged. If you charge the battery outside of
this temperature range, you may not be able to efficiently charge the battery pack.
After charging is completed, either disconnect the cable from the DC IN jack on your
camcorder or remove the battery pack.
When you play back a dual sound track tape recorded in an AFM HiFi stereo system,
set HiFi SOUND to the desired mode in the menu settings (p. 104).
Additional Information
186
187
About i.LINK
If the battery pack is not used for a long time, do the following procedure once per
year to maintain proper function.
1. Fully charge the battery.
2. Discharge on your electronic equipment.
3. Remove the battery from the equipment and store it in a dry, cool place.
To use the battery pack up on your camcorder, leave your camcorder in the standby
mode until the power goes off without a cassette inserted.
What is i.LINK?
i.LINK is a digital serial interface for handling digital video, digital audio and other
data in two directions between equipment having the i.LINK jack, and for controlling
other equipment.
i.LINK-compatible equipment can be connected by a single i.LINK cable. Possible
applications are operations and data transactions with various digital AV equipment.
When two or more i.LINK-compatible equipment are connected to this unit in a daisy
chain, operations and data transactions are possible with not only the equipment that
this unit is connected to but also with other devices via the directly connected
equipment.
Note, however, that the method of operation sometimes varies according to the
characteristics and specifications of the equipment to be connected, and that operations
and data transactions are sometimes not possible on some connected equipment.
Battery life
The battery life is limited. Battery capacity drops little by little as you use it more and
more, and as time passes. When the available battery time is shortened considerably, a
probable cause is that the battery pack has reached the end of its life. Buy a new
battery pack.
The battery life varies according to how it is stored and operating conditions and
environment for each battery pack.
Note
Normally, only one piece of equipment can be connected to this unit by the i.LINK
cable (DV cable). When connecting this unit to i.LINK-compatible equipment having
two or more i.LINK jacks (DV jacks), refer to the operating instructions of the
equipment to be connected.
i.LINK is a more familiar term for IEEE 1394 data transport bus proposed by SONY,
and is a trademark approved by many corporations.
IEEE 1394 is an international standard standardized by the Institute of Electrical and
Electronic Engineers.
Additional Information
i.LINKs maximum baud rate varies according to the equipment. Three maximum baud
rates are defined:
S100 (approx. 100 Mbps*)
S200 (approx. 200 Mbps)
S400 (approx. 400 Mbps)
The baud rate is listed under Specifications in the operating instructions of each
equipment. It is also indicated near the i.LINK jack on some equipment.
The maximum baud rate of equipment on which it is not indicated such as this unit is
S100.
When units are unit is connected to equipment having a different maximum baud rate,
the baud rate sometimes differs from the indicated baud rate.
* What is Mbps?
Mbps stands for megabits per second, or the amount of data that can be sent or received
in one second. For example, a baud rate of 100 Mbps means that 100 megabits of data
can be sent in one second.
188
189
1-46
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
About i.LINK
i.LINK functions on this unit
For details on how to dub when this unit is connected to other video equipment having
DV jacks, see page 71, 135.
This unit can also be connected to other i.LINK (DV) compatible equipment made by
SONY (e.g. VAIO series personal computer) other than video equipment.
Before connecting this unit to a personal computer, make sure that application software
supported by this unit is already installed on the personal computer.
For details on precautions when connecting this unit, also refer to the operating
instructions of the equipment to be connected.
You can use your camcorder in any country or area with the AC power adaptor
supplied with your camcorder within 100 V to 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz.
When charging the battery pack, use a commercially available AC plug adaptor [a], if
necessary, depending on the design of the wall outlet [b].
AC-L10A/L10B/L10C
[a]
[b]
NTSC system
Bahama Islands, Bolivia, Canada, Central America, Chile, Colombia, Ecuador, Jamaica,
Japan, Korea, Mexico, Peru, Surinam, Taiwan, the Philippines, the U.S.A., Venezuela,
etc.
PAL-M system
Brazil
Additional Information
PAL system
Australia, Austria, Belgium, China, Czech Republic, Denmark, Finland, Germany, Great
Britain, Holland, Hong Kong, Italy, Kuwait, Malaysia, New Zealand, Norway, Portugal,
Singapore, Slovak Republic, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Thailand, etc.
PAL-N system
Argentina, Paraguay, Uruguay
SECAM system
Bulgaria, France, Guyana, Hungary, Iran, Iraq, Monaco, Poland, Russia, Ukraine, etc.
190
191
Moisture condensation
Maintenance information
Cleaning the video heads
If your camcorder is brought directly from a cold place to a warm place, moisture may
condense inside your camcorder, on the surface of the tape, or on the lens. In this state,
the tape may stick to the head drum and be damaged or your camcorder may not
operate correctly. If there is moisture inside your camcorder, the beep sounds and the %
indicator flashes. When the Z indicator flashes at the same time, the cassette is inserted
in your camcorder. If moisture condenses on the lens, the indicator will not appear.
To ensure normal recording and clear pictures, clean the video heads.
When you playback/record in the Digital8 system
The video head may be dirty when:
Mosaic-pattern noise appears on the playback picture.
Playback pictures do not move.
Playback pictures are hardly visible.
Playback pictures do not appear.
The x indicator and CLEANING CASSETTE message appear one after another.
or
or
Additional Information
If the above problem occurs, clean the video heads with the Sony V8-25CLD cleaning
cassette (optional). Check the picture and if the above problem persists, repeat cleaning.
192
193
1-47
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Remove the tape, and periodically turn on the power, operate the CAMERA and VCR
sections and play back a tape for about three minutes when your camcorder is not to
be used for a long time.
Clean the lens with a soft brush to remove dust. If there are fingerprints on the lens,
remove them with a soft cloth.
Clean the camcorder body with a dry soft cloth, or a soft cloth lightly moistened with
a mild detergent solution. Do not use any type of solvent which may damage the
finish.
Do not let sand get into your camcorder. When you use your camcorder on a sandy
beach or in a dusty place, protect it from the sand or dust. Sand or dust may cause
your camcorder to malfunction, and sometimes this malfunction cannot be repaired.
Your camcorder is supplied with a built-in rechargeable battery installed to retain the
date and time, etc., regardless of the setting of the POWER switch. The built-in
rechargeable battery is always charged as long as you are using your camcorder. The
battery, however, will become discharged gradually if you do not use your camcorder.
It will be completely discharged in about half a year if you do not use your camcorder
at all. Even if the built-in rechargeable battery is not charged, it will not affect
camcorder operation. To retain the date, time, and other information, charge the battery
if the battery is discharged.
Charging the built-in rechargeable battery:
Connect your camcorder to wall outlet using the AC power adaptor supplied with
your camcorder, and leave your camcorder with the POWER switch turned off for
more than 24 hours.
Or, install a fully charged battery pack in your camcorder, and leave your camcorder
with the POWER switch set to OFF (CHG) for more than 24 hours.
AC power adaptor
Precautions
Operate your camcorder on 7.2 V (battery pack) or 8.4 V (AC power adaptor).
For DC or AC operation, use the accessories recommended in these operating
instructions.
If any solid object or liquid gets inside the casing, unplug your camcorder and have it
checked by a Sony dealer before operating it any further.
Avoid rough handling or mechanical shock. Be particularly careful of the lens.
Keep the POWER switch set to OFF (CHG) when you are not using your camcorder.
Do not wrap your camcorder with a towel, for example, and operate it. Doing so
might cause heat to build up inside.
Keep your camcorder away from strong magnetic fields or mechanical vibration.
Noise may appear on the image.
Do not touch the LCD screen with your fingers or a sharp-pointed object.
If your camcorder is used in a cold place, a residual image may appear on the screen.
This is not a malfunction.
While using your camcorder, the back of the LCD screen may heat up. This is not a
malfunction.
On handling tapes
Additional Information
Unplug the unit from the wall outlet when you are not using it for a long time. To
disconnect the power cord, pull it out by the plug. Never pull the power cord itself.
Do not operate the unit with a damaged cord or if the unit has been dropped or
damaged.
Do not bend the power cord forcibly, or place a heavy object on it. This will damage
the cord and may cause fire or electric shock.
Prevent metallic objects from coming into contact with the metal parts of the
connecting section. If this happens, a short may occur and the unit may be damaged.
Always keep metal contacts clean.
Do not disassemble the unit.
Do not apply mechanical shock or drop the unit.
While the unit is in use, particularly during charging, keep it away from AM receivers
and video equipment. AM receivers and video equipment disturb AM reception and
video operation.
The unit becomes warm during use. This is not a malfunction.
Do not place the unit in locations that are:
Extremely hot or cold
Dusty or dirty
Very humid
Vibrating
Camcorder operation
Do not insert anything into the small holes on the rear of the cassette. These holes are
used to sense the type and thickness of the tape and if the recording tab is in or out.
Do not open the tape protect cover or touch the tape.
194
195
Quick Reference
Camcorder
Wipe the surface of the lens clean with a soft cloth in the following instances:
When there are fingerprints on the lens surface
In hot or humid locations
When the lens is used in environments susceptible to salt such as the seaside
Store the lens in a well-ventilated location subject to little dirt or dust.
5
1
Battery pack
Use only the specified charger or video equipment with the charging function.
To prevent accident from a short circuit, do not allow metal objects to come into
contact with the battery terminals.
Keep the battery pack away from fire.
Never expose the battery pack to temperatures above 60C (140F), such as in a car
parked in the sun or under direct sunlight.
Keep the battery pack dry.
Do not expose the battery pack to any mechanical shock.
Do not disassemble nor modify the battery pack.
Attach the battery pack to the video equipment securely.
Charging while some capacity remains does not affect the original battery capacity.
To avoid possible damage from battery leakage or corrosion, observe the following:
Be sure to insert the batteries with the + and correctly matching the + and inside
the battery compartment.
Dry batteries are not rechargeable.
Do not use a combination of new and old batteries.
Do not use different types of batteries.
Current flows from batteries when you are not using them for a long time.
Do not use leaking batteries.
8
3
9
0
Quick Reference
196
199
1-48
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
PLAY
PAUSE
REC
FF
MEMORY
qj
qa
DELETE MPEG
wh
MEMORY
MIX
PLAY
STOP
INDEX
qs
qk
ql
w;
qd
qf
wf
wj
wk
wl
wg
e;
wa
qg
ws
wd
qh
qa SUPER NS/COLOR SLOW S button
(p. 28)
qd Lens
qf Microphone
qg Camera recording lamp (p. 20)
Quick Reference
* DCR-TRV340 only
Attaching the lens cap
Attach the lens cap to the grip strap as illustrated.
201
200
ea
es
eh
ed
ef
ej
ek
eg
el
r;
ra
rd
rs
rf
rg
rk
eh PHOTO button (p. 38, 122)
ed Speaker
rh
rj
rl
t;
* DCR-TRV340 only
rh Eyecup
rs Grip strap
202
1-49
Quick Reference
203
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
td
8
9
ta
3
tf
4
5
ts
ta S VIDEO jack (p. 37, 70, 134)
td
Quick Reference
204
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
50min
W
SP
REC 0:00:00
M.FADER
16:9WIDE
SEPIA
8
9
0
qa
ZERO SET
MEMORY
DATE 01
SEARCH
A/V DV
16B I T
qs
1 Recording mode (p. 20)
/Mirror mode (p. 25)
2 Format (p. 185)
,
or indicator appears.
3 Remaining battery time
(p. 26, 34)
4 Zoom (p. 23)/Exposure (p. 52)
5 Fader (p. 44)/Digital effect (p. 48, 63)
6 Wide mode (p. 41)/FRAME indicator
(DCR-TRV340 only) (p. 122)
7 Picture effect (p. 46, 62)
8 Volume (p. 33)/Data code (p. 34)
9 PROGRAM AE (p. 51)
0 Backlight (p. 27)
qa SteadyShot off (p. 106)
qs Manual focusing (p. 53)
206
Display window
qd
qf
qg
qh
qj
qk
ql
w;
wj
wh
wa
ws
wd
wf
wg
qh Remaining tape (p. 26)
qj ZERO SET MEMORY (p. 66)
qk Search mode (p. 31, 67, 68)
ql NIGHTSHOT (p. 28)/SUPER NIGHTSHOT
(p. 28)/COLOR SLOW SHUTTER (p. 28)
w; A/V t DV (p. 87)/DV IN (p. 90)
wa Audio mode (p. 111)
ws Warning (p. 183)
wd Recording lamp (p. 20)
This indicator appears in the viewfinder.
wf Video flash ready (p. 105)
This indicator appears when you use the
video flash light (optional).
wg Video flash mode (p. 105)
This indicator appears when you use the
video flash light (optional).
1-50E
205
SECTION 2
DISASSEMBLY
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
[CONNECTION OF EQUIPMENTS]
CN1108
1
20
CPC-13 jig
(J-6082-443-A)
Adjustment remote
commander (RM-95)
Remove the
CPC lid (BT)
MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
AC power
adaptor
2-1
AC IN
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4 Two claws
Two claws
2 Four claws
0
-16
PD oard
B
4 Two claws
qd P frame (2)
qa Claw
D
C
6 LCD holder
7 Remove
the two
solderings.
8 FP-414
flexible board
2 Two claws
Adjustment remote
commander (RM-95)
Indication LCD block assembly
CN5502
0
-16
PD oard
B
DC IN
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
PD-160 board
Multi CPC jig
(J-6082-311-A)
2-2
AC IN
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1
4 Two MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
3 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
6 FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
2 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
5 Claw
Remove it while taking
care as the FP-406 flexible
cable is connected.
3 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
2 Two tapping
screws
(M1.7 5)
7 Front panel
section
qg Front panel
assembly (24)
B
qf Microphone
Cushion (F)
qd Microphone
holder
qa Microphone (4P)
1 Cushion (1), F
q; Microphone retainer
8 Sheet microphone
7 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
qs Microphone
9 Two claws
5 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
Microphone
holder
Microphone
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
FP-411 flexible
board
AC IN
When removing it, be careful not
to damage the harnesses, etc.
DC IN
FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
SI-032 board
2-3
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
qs Two MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
2 Three claws
qa Three MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
3 Cabinet
(upper)
q; Three MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
7 Claw
9 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
5 Claw
6 Jack cover retainer
8 Jack cover
4 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
qd Night-Shot switch of
Lens device (LSV-700A)
qg Harness
(PD-117) (20P)
2-4
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
A
B
4 Stepping
motor Z700
(Zoom)
4 Lens section
3 Iris flexible
assembly (24P)
q;
1 FP-161 flexible
board (16P)
9 Iris flexible
assembly
7 CD-357 board
6 CCD block
assembly
5 Stepping
motor F700
(Focus)
2 Two tapping
screws (B1.7 6)
2 Two tapping
screws (M1.7 5)
5 Remove the
solderings
7 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
LANC
jack
AC IN
FP-411 flexible
board
SI-032 board
Harness
(PD-117) (20P)
FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
Cabinet (R) block section
2-5
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
(TRV240)
FP-407
flexible board
5 EVF
section
VF hinge
assembly
(TRV340)
3 Three screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
1 FP-407 flexible
board (20P)
5 Claw
1 Two claws
9 FP-407 flexible
board (20P)
6 EVF cabinet
(upper) assembly
4 LCD (LCX032AP-5)
(16P)
2 Two claws
8 EVF cabinet
(lower) assembly
1 Pull of the
adhesive side.
3 Two tapping
screws (M1.7 5)
9 VF lens (B)
assembly
8 LCD
(LCX032AP-5)
4 Four tapping
screws
(M1.7 5)
7 Prism sheet
6 Illuminator
5 LB-076
board
3 Lamp guide
CPC-13 jig
(J-6082-443-A)
DC IN
Adjustment remote
commander (RM-95)
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
Control switch block
(CF-2500) (22P)
LANC
jack
FP-411 flexible
board
SI-032 board
AC IN
LB-076 board
FP-407 flexible
board (20P)
Harness
(PD-117) (20P)
FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
2-6
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
6 Two MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
REMOVING THE
BATTERY TERMINAL BOARD
5 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
7 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
6 Battery terminal
board
2 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
8
A
1 Jack lid
(2500)
1 Tape (A)
2 Ferrite
bead
3 FP-409 flexible
board (10P)
9 Battery panel
section
4 Battery terminal
board (6P)
5Strap sheet
metal (lower)
6 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
4 MS section
1 Screw
(M1.7 2.5), p
2 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
2-7
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
A
6
4 Two dowels
VC
Bo -27
ar 6
d
B
8 Remove the control switch block
(SS-1380) in the direction
of the arrow B.
7 Two dowels
5 Tapping screw
(M1.7 5)
1 Tape (A)
2 Control switch block
(SS-1380) (12P)
OK
NG
2 Screw
(M1.7 2.5), p
5 External (hot shoe) connector,
Shoe frame
3 Crow
1 Screw
(M1.7 2.5), p
8 Four dowels
9 Cabinet (L)
section
A
A
4 FP-264 flexible
board (15P)
5 Cabinet (L)
assembly
1 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
6
-27
VCard
Bo
7 Screw
(M1.7 2.5), p
4 Grip
belt (ES)
3 Two MI screws
(M2 4) (H)
6 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
6 CS frame
assembly (25)
2-8
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2-10.VC-276 BOARD
D
C
BC
D
5
8 VC-276 board
7 VC sheet
6
-27
C
d
V ar
Bo
4 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
2 Screw
(M1.7 2.5), p
6 FP-264 flexible
board (20P)
1 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
3 FP-410 flexible board
2-11.MECHANISM DECK
V
B Co 27
a 6
rd
5 MD frame
4
6 Mechanism
deck
3 Three dowels
2 Three screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
2-9
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Note : If the machine malfunctions (the operating mode changes by itself), connect the Cabinet (R) section.
Battery panel
section
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
AC IN
DC IN
Battery terminal
board (6P)
CPC-13 jig
(J-6082-443-A)
CN1108
V
B Co 2
a 7
rd 6
Mechanism deck
VC-276
board
FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
FP-410
flexible board
Harness
(PD-117) (20P)
FP-411
flexible board
LANC
jack
Adjustment remote
commander (RM-95)
SI-032 board
2-10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Note : If the machine malfunctions (the operating mode changes by itself), connect the Cabinet (R) section.
Battery panel
section
AC POWER
ADAPTOR
DC IN
Mechanism deck
Battery terminal
board (6P)
FP-161 flexible
board (16P)
CD-357 board
V
B Co 2
a 7
rd 6
Lens section
VC-276
board
Iris flexible
assembly (24P)
FP-411
flexible board
FP-406 flexible
board (30P)
FP-410
flexible board
Harness
(PD-117) (20P)
LANC
jack
Adjustment remote
commander (RM-95)
Cabinet (R) block section
SI-032 board
2-11
AC IN
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
5 Harness (PD-117)
(6P)
1 MI screw
(M2 4) (H)
6 Three tapping screws
(B2 5)
2 Tripod retainer,
Tripod screw (Y)
7 Claw
Harness
(PD-117)
Tape (A)
2-12
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2-14.HINGE SECTION
REMOVING THE HINGE ASSEMBLY
1 Harness
(PD-117)
(6, 20P)
A
2 FP-412 flexible
board (6P)
2 Hinge
assembly
1 Two claws
1 Harness
(PD-117)
3 Hinge
cover (M)
5 Claw
4 Two screws
(M1.7 2.5), p
6 FP-412 flexible board
7 For removing the LCD unit
(See page 2-2)
6 Four tapping
screws (B2 5)
2 Harness
(PD-117) (6P)
4 Two claws
Harness
(PD-117)
Tape (A)
1 Tape (A)
2-13
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
CD-357
VC-276
SI-032
PD-160
NAME
CD-357
LB-076
PD-160
SI-032
VC-276
FUNCTION
CCD IMAGER
EVF BACK LIGHT
CHA, DISPLAY DRIVE, BACK LIGHT/LCD DRIVE, TG
STEADY SHOT, LASER LINK
CAMERA, VIDEO, DV INTERFACE, CAMERA/MECHA/HI CONTROL, AUDIO,
D/D CONVERTER
2-14
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
FP-407
FP-264
FP-161
FP-409
(MEMORY STICK MODEL)
(TRV340)
FP-412
IRIS FLEXIBLE
ASSEMBLY
FP-406
FP-410
2-15E
FP-414
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SECTION 3
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
CD-357 BOARD
VC-276 BOARD(1/5)
LENS ASSY
(4-8)
(4-30)
IRIS
IC1502
IC551
NIGHT
SHOT
M904
ZOOM MOTOR
M905
FOCUS MOTOR
ZOOM
RESET
SENSOR
CN1501
CCD
IMAGER
IRIS
METER
FOCUS
RESET
SENSOR
14
16
V1-V4,RG,H1,H2
CCD OUT
14
1
18
(4-29)
1
2
15
16
IC1501
31
TIMING
GENERATOR
18
CN551
CN1551
12 13
10
ZOOM
A,B,XA,XB
ZM RST
FC RST
XNS SW
17 19
21
FOCUS
A,B,XA,XB
2
IC1553
ZOOM
MOTOR
DRIVE
13 16
IRIS
HALL(-)
X1501
27MHz
8
IC1552
(4-33)
FOCUS
MOTOR
DRIVE
9 12
EN1
DIR1A
DIR1B
IRIS DRIVE(-)
21 23
19
HALL
AMP
CK CONT
(IC4501)
IRIS
DRIVE
(4-34)
7
EN0
DIR0A
DIR0B
CAM CS
(IC4501)
10
HALL
AD
12
30
CLPDM
XSHP 19
XSHD
21
PBLK
S/H
AGC
CAM
2
A/D
CONV.
LINE
AD0-AD9
AD0-AD9
11
PB
HD,VD
16
23
34 36
AD0-AD9
46 47 48
VCK
ADCK
ADCK
MF PHOTO
SENSOR
FOCUS
RING
PB C RF
39
SE301
LIA1
PITCH SENSOR
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-13)
J301
(HEADPHONES)
L,R
J302
MIC
(PLUG IN
POWER)
L,R
SE302
YAW SENSOR
12
13
9
10
LIA2
24
12
PITCH/YAW
SENSOR
AMP
VCO
MIC
R
CN302
(4-14)
REMOTE
COMMANDER
RECEIVER
12
11
25
24
15
14
13
1
12
19
CN1103
36
48
AS DATA
IC6002
8
11
158
(PAGE 3-3)
49
213
2
6
IC3603
D1118
9
6
4
CN1101
IR ON
SIRCS PWM
STB ON
(4-66)
AUDIO
IN/OUT
L,R
3
2
7
8
L,R
15
16
Y0-Y7
Y0-Y7
C0-C7
C0-C7
49
42
38
37
36
34
AFCK
31
68
SPCK
(IC1401)
66 64 63
AUDIO
A/D CONV.
D/A CONV.
4
5
59
65
IC5702
HD,VD,OE
HD,VD,OE
RXD,TXD
XCS IC3603
(IC4501)
DATA TO SFD
DATA FROM SFD
SFD BCK
AS DATA
8
9
12
VD SO,VD SI,VD SCK
MCLK
55
56
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(3/5)
(PAGE 3-5)
14
26
AFM FSC(IC2201)
PB C RF
PB RF
Y
C
Y
C
SHOE MIC L
XCS IC3701
(IC4501)
9
11
INTELLIGENT
ACCESSORY
SHOE(1/2)
(4-56)
IR L,R
(4-65)
XCS AU1
(IC4501)
23
52
VIDEO
A/D
CONV.
(4-49)
IC5701
64
3
57
58
SP+,- 49
51
13
AUDIO
A/D CONV.
3
2
CN1104
J201(2/2)
AUDIO/VIDEO
63
2
35
1
MCLK
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-27)
22 MIC L,R
14
18
CN304
J201(1/2)
S VIDEO
HP L,R 52
54
IC5801
MIC
AMP
D301,302
(IR EMITTER)
SIRCS SIG
33
3
DOP
(IC3201)
51
20 22
IC301
FP-410(1/3)
19
20
6
7
16
17
77
66
67
(PAGE 4-13)
MECHA HD,VD
TBC VD
YAW AD
(4-20)
XCS IC2201
(IC4501)
(PAGE 3-7)
18
98
FC RST,ZM RST
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(2/5)
(4-69)
SI-032 BOARD
(1/2)
ATF IN
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(4/5)
PITCH AD
MIC901
MIC
L
RF AGC OUT
PITCH AD,YAW AD
STB ON
2
CK CONT
(IC4501)
MECHA HD
MECHA VD
93 TBC VD
94
53
MF A,B
30
28
26
101
95
CAM SO,CAM SI,CAM SCK
IC2001
SPCK
(IC1401)
(4-32)
97
CAM SO 38
SCK 37
FP-411(1/2)
HI8/STD8
PB Y/C
PROCESS
ATF
44
45
47
CN301
1
3
198
79
AFM FSC
81
EN0,EN1
DIR 0 A,B
DIR 1 A,B
IC2201
IRIS PWM
MF A,B
185
VCK
1
5
ADCK
VCK
IRIS PWM,HALL AD
FC RST,ZM RST
X NS SW
PH301,302
196
187
V
V
11
39
48
18
14
10
36
(4-48)
IC3701
34
46
42
22
VIDEO
IN/OUT
AGC
ACC
7
44
5
Y
C
C
SP+,-
Y
C
10
IR ON,
SIRCS PWM
SIRCS SIG
SIRCS SIG
13
15
RXD,TXD
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(5/5)
(PAGE 3-10,12)
16
(DCR-TRV340)
3-1
3-2
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
177
IC1401
191
CAMERA
PROCESS
AD0-AD9
MPEG
MOVIE
PROCESS
182
HD,VD
DSCK
115
Y0-Y7
172
99
199
97
CO-C3
91
CAMERA
195
196
FC RST,ZM RST
61
62
AUDIO
76
59
LINE IN
HI8/STD8 PB
72
C0-C7
65
84
HD,VD,OE
HD,VD,OE
RXD,TXD
(PAGE
3-5)
ADAI2
ADAO2
88
123
86
SFD BCK
VR,VG,VB
21
(4-35)
A0-A11
C0-C3
IC1402
35
HD,VD,OE
SDRAM
D0-D15
13
42
137
133
56
170
38
LXCS(IC4901)
47
34
27 22
10
VD SO,VD SCK
PANEL XHD
PANEL XVD
18
IC5101
SDRAM
16Mbit
CS FLASH
(IC4901)
26
IC5102
FLASH
MEMORY
16Mbit
44
IC5502
35
7
8
1
48
(4-21)
PSIG
VP
DAC
19
24
22
CN5501
Q5601
BL CONT
TO
OVER ALL
BLOCK
(5/5)
17
1-9
16-25
48
238
CN1104
USB D+,D-
21
24
93
(4-38)
29-45
LXCS(IC1401)
IC5601
2
7
6
PANEL 2.8V
215
60
(1/2)
214
213
39
DIGITAL
STILL
CONTROL
CN1105
5
3
7
109
IC4905
184
RXD, TXD
221
(USB)
XTAL
OSC
MS DIO
MS BS
MS SCLK
MEMORY
STICK
FP-409
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-64)
DSCK(IC1401)
187
CS FLASH (IC5102)
CN203
116
113
3
2
(PAGE 4-27)
IC4901
CS SDRAM (IC5101)
D+
D-
X4901
48MHz
222
XTAL 48M LK
(DCR-TRV340)
3-3
2.5
INCH
LCD UNIT
T5601
Q5602/Q5604
ND901
BACKLIGHT
BL HIGH
10
INVERTER
3-4
BL REG
BACK
LIGHT
DRIVE
(4-20)
IC5602
BL LOW
CN5601
DET IN
5
(FLEXIBLE)
239
LCD901
FP-410(2/3)
62
CN5502
FOR
ADJUSTMENTS
1
CN5701
6
2
7
8
12
13
15
(PAGE 3-10)
(DCR-TRV240)
2-12
39-49
D0-D15
(4-40)
(4-21)
8
4
5
3
1
4
5
3
HD OUT
A1-A23
CS SDARM
(IC4901)
AD17-AD19
19-32
40
39
TIMING
GENERATOR
11
(4-39)
36
20
VR,VG,VB
22
24
27
9
11
(4-20)
DSCK
(IC1401)
RGB
DRIVE
46
45
42
XCS IC1401
(IC4501)
46
36
(PAGE
3-5)
(PAGE
3-7)
135
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(3/5)
(VC-276)
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(4/5)
CAM CS
(IC4501)
53
48
MEMCK
54
DIGITAL
STILL
PROCESS
153
53
(DCR-TRV340)
55
IC5501
41
USB D+,DXCS LCD
144
48
47
46
3
4
5
COL0-COL3
120
130
PANEL R
PANEL G
PANEL B
OSD HD,OSD VD
44
Y0-Y7
HD OUT
PSIG
PD-160 BOARD(1/2)
87
CHARACTER
GENERATOR
85
AFCK(IC3603)
HD,VD,OE
119
Y0-Y7
C0-C7
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(3/5)
117
118
83
Y0-Y7
(PAGE
@3-5)
SPCK
25
207
(PAGE
@3-2)
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(3/5)
74
171
EN0,EN1
DIR0A,B
DIR1A,B
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(1/5)
(4-35)
CURRENT
DET
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
CN202
DV IN/OUT
VC-276 BOARD(3/5)
AFCK(IC3603)
196
(4-41)
SPCK(IC1401)
48
IC3301
199
203
207
213
Y0-Y7
1
5
C0-C3
ADAI2
ADAI2
(PAGE 3-3)
ADAO2
SFD BCK
3
7
(DCR-TRV240)
X6001
48MHZ
XTAL 48MLK
(IC4905)
25
31
79
USB D+,D- 78
47
54
57
58
33
41
Y0-Y7
(4-55)
2
6
9
C4-C7
46
202
206
212
216
HD,VD,OE
XCS IC6001
(IC4501)
14
47
79
29
FP-410(3/3)
MC BUS
37
(FLEXIBLE)
VREF
RF MON
(PAGE 4-27)
REC CK
REC DT
AD DT
6
AD DT
6
61
66
56
(4-45)
15
42
IC3101
20
PB CK
ATF ERR
81
79
PB CK
40
42
170
PB Y OUT
DV PB RF
25
22 24
FLYING
ERASE
CN3101
1
2
7
6
REC/PB
AMP
5
4
7
8
ODD
EVEN
Q3117
Q3111,3116
Q3107
Q3109
Q3119,3120
27
FLYING
ERASE
OSC
FILTER
SW
29
EQ
A/D CONV.
PLL
13
SP2
EVEN
11
35
31
179
18
HD,VD,OE 22
24
XFE ON
159
DRUM 8PB
XCS TRF
(IC4501)
7
6
140
139
DRUM
SP1
ODD
IC3103
REC CK
REC DT
MC BUS
27
28
42
CN1108(2/4)
FOR
ADJUSTMENTS
(4-46)
88
4
8
15
16
5
PB RF (IC3201 14 )
161
C0 \C3
DV INTERFACE
83
17
(PAGE 3-3)
TRCK
LCK
17
34
Y0 \Y7
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(2/5)
42
TPA+,TPB+,-
99
97
IC6001
USB
I/F
IC3303
L BUS
152
FRRV,TRRV,TRRT
153
156
DATA TO SFD
133
DATA FROM SFD
132
SFD BCK
127
134
43
45
151
200
204
208
214
CN1104
(4-43)
142
51
141
127
OSD HD
OSD VD 184
183
COLO
195
COL3 194
191
190
OSD HD,OSD VD
COLO-COL3
X3301
24.576MHz
139
145
135
ADAO2
SFD BCK
SPCK
(IC1401)
DV SIGNAL
PROCESS
17
21
23
HD,VD,OE
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(2/5)
201
205
211
215
138
LCK(IC3301)
ASDATA
MCLK
75
73
71
20
18
21
105
106
RF SWP
163
162
ATF ERR
FRRV,TRRV,TRRT
PANEL G
PANEL R
RF ENV DET
PANEL B
TO
OVERALL BLOCK
(4/5)
PANEL XHD,XVD
MC BUS
64
65 82 63
(PAGE 3-7)
55
59
67
BW Y
DATA TO SFD
CAM SO,CAM SCK
AS DATA
VD SO, VD SCK
(4-51)
MCLK
(PAGE 3-2)
IC3201
RF AGC OUT(PB Y RF)
PB C RF
HI8/STD8
PB RF
AMP
EVF VG
18
DV PB RF
VCO
12
11
CN1108(3/4)
FOR
ADJUSTMENTS
11
PB RF
LB-076 BOARD
14
Y
C
(4-52)
SP+,-
BL CONT
DOP
(IC2201)
RF ENV
DET
VG
LCD903
(PAGE 3-10,12)
IC3202
7
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK
(5/5)
IC7001
48
47
46
BW Y
RGB
DRIVE
CN701
20
VR,VG,VB
22
24
9
8
10
12
13
11
19
CN702
14
15
13
B/W
LCD UNIT
41
VSP SO, VSP SI, X VSP SCK
39
XCS EVF
(IC4501)
(4-70)
3
4
5
10
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(2/5)
(PD-160)
PANEL R
PANEL G
PANEL B
IC2291
ADJUSTMENT
VOLTAGE
D/A CONV.
(EVR)
XCS LCD
(IC4501)
(4-53)
IC7002
45
15
46
42
VD SO,VD SCK
PANEL XHD
PANEL XVD
1
48
TIMING
GENERATOR
9
11
VCO
1
2
PANEL XHD,XVD
CN1110
BL CONT
13
24
20
17
IC701
LED
DRIVE
2
CN004
(PAGE 4-23)
16
3-5
(4-10)
LED ON/OFF
CONTROL SWITCH
BLOCK (CF-2500)
(1/2)
CN1106
14
CN7001
VD SO, VD SCK
SP+,-
7
8
17
(4-53)
2
(PAGE 3-4)
LED DA
12
44
27
28
35
40
3-6
SP901
SPEAKER
D701
(BACK LIGHT)
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
VC-276 BOARD(4/5)
(4-58)
(4-60)
IC4501
69
70
67
52
MECHA
CONTROL
SIGNAL
PROCESS
CONTROL
CAMERA
CONTROL
(4-58)
88
89
DRUM PWM
CAP PWM
CAP PWM
IC4401
28
25
(3/3)
LPF
29
27
DRUM ERROR
CAP ERROR
IC1301
15
11
(1/2)
PWM
DRIVE
58
64
Q1306
SWITCHING
197
198
DRUM FG
DRUM FG
DRUM PG
DRUM PG
(PAGE 3-6)
155
215
97
16
FG AMP
17
DRUM FG
22
PG AMP
20
DRUM PG
CAP VS
190
CAP FG
CN4403
14
U,V,W
5
7
9
CAPSTAN
MOTOR
DRIVE
XCS EEP
HU,HV,HW
2
21
EEPROM
XCS TRF(IC3101)
VREF(IC3301)
RF SWP
12
119
204
106
107
108
38
39
DA STB (IC2291)
59
24
DEW AD
DEW AD
LOAD
UNLOAD
LOAD
UNLOAD
TAPE END
TAPE END
TAPE TOP
TAPE TOP
T REEL FG
T REEL FG
S REEL FG
XCS IC1401
11
XCS IC3603
XCS AU1(IC5701)
42
43
XCS IC3701
99
XCS IC2201
154
S REEL FG
193
180
109
120
82
83
80
CAM CS(IC1501,1401)
MECHA HD
MECHA VD
TBC VD
(PAGE 3-2)
IRIS PWM
STB ON
IRIS PWM
STB ON
HALL AD
FC RST
ZM RST
XNS SW
MF A
MF B
PITCH AD
YAW AD
22
DEW SENSOR
21
S901
MODE SWITCH
TAPE LED ON
CN4401
(2/3)
55
56
LOADING
MOTOR
DRIVE
47
TAPE END
DETECT
46
44
TAPE TOP
DETECT
45
41
T REEL
FG AMP
38
39
33
S REEL
FG AMP
36
35
TAPE LED ON
LM(+),LM(-)
53
51
TAPE END(C)
161
TAPE TOP(C)
14
Q001
173
202
205
135
62
73
71
66
65
63
T REEL(+),(-)
7
6
T REEL
SENSOR
H001
S REEL(+),(-)
9
10
S REEL
SENSOR
H002
Q4401
LED DRIVE
13
X4501
20MHZ
CAP FG
RF SWP (IC4501
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(5/5)
(PAGE 3-10,12)
HI SO,HI SI,X HI SCK
94
175
128
56
54
41
210
211
129
130
64
16
3-7
TAPE END
SENSOR
TAPE TOP
SENSOR
ME SW
HI8 MP SW
ZOOM VR AD
D001
TAPE
LED
15
S001
REC PROOF
ME SW
HI8 MP SW
XCC DOWN
REC PROOF
XCC DOWN
M
Q002
3
4
2
1
CN4404
77
78
75
M903
LOADING MOTOR
CAPSTAN FG
19
(PAGE 3-3)
18
16
MODE SW A-C
MODE SW A-C
IC4401
15
13
196
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(2/5)
FG1,2
22
23
FG AMP
(4-58)
172
170
23
115
XFE ON
DRUM 8 PB
RF ENV DET
VD SO, VD SCK
CAP FG
10
IC4502
HALL AD
FC RST
ZM RST
XNS SW
MF A,B
PITCH AD
YAW AD
9
7
HU1,2
HV1,2
HW1,2
16
M902
CAPSTAN MOTOR
(4-60)
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(1/5)
IC4402
XCS VFD(IC3301)
XCS SFD(IC3301)
XCS IC6001
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(3/5)
U, V, W
10
(4-57)
111
61
59
57
DRUM
MOTOR
DRIVE
ATF ERR
IC4401
(1/3)
SWITCHING
Q1305
84
178
179
FRRV,TRRT,TRRV
M901
DRUM MOTOR
CN4402
DRUM VS
(4-73)
MC BUS
45
DRUM PWM
3-8
172 )
15
13
8
REC PROOF
ME/MP
HI8 MP
C.C. LOCK
S002
CN1108(4/4)
FOR
ADJUSTMENTS
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
VC-276 BOARD(5/5)
104 DIAL A
105 DIAL B
14
13
S007
4
12
10
9
7
12
11
FUNCTION
SW
S001
OPEN/CLOSE
SW
IC4701
RESET
IC5701
20
30
INDICATOR
DRIVE
(4-19)
BT001
LITHIUM
BATTERY
3
7
VTR UNREG
VDD SWITCH
67 XRESET
PANEL
REVERSE
SW
CN5702
CN5704
BATT UNREG
19
10
16
23 LCD COM/XDATA
XOSD SCK
OSD SO
LCD COM/XDATA
XCS LCD DRIVER
CN005
CN5701
1
2
FP-412
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-19)
OSD SO 31
OSD SI 32
OSD CS 125
XPANEL REV
IC4703
PD-160 BOARD(2/2)
11
HI SO 53
HI SI 52
HI SCK 54
S001
POWER
SW
(PAGE 4-27)
S003
OPEN/EJECT SW
KEY AD5
XPHOTO FREEZ
LANC
I/O
6 XPHOTO FREEZ
XS/S SW
3 XS/S SW
XVTR MODE SW
XCAM MODE SW
XPHOTO STBY SW
1
4
3
1
2
7
XVTR MODE SW
XCAM MODE SW
XPHOTO STBY SW
(PAGE 3-7)
SIRCS SIG
IR ON
SIRCS PWM
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(1/5)
IR ON 20
BL CONT
BATT/EXT SW
FAST CHARGE
INIT CHARGE ON
SHOE ON
171
85
24
21
12
XEJECT SW
ZOOM VR AD
11
IC4802
(4-61)
EEPROM
45 HI EVER SD
44 HI EVER SI
46 HI EVER SCK
43 XCS EEPROM
BL REG
USB 3.1V
D 1.9V
D 2.8V
AU 2.8V
A 2.8V
A 4.75V
AU 4.75V
RP 4.75V
MT 5V
EP 4.75V
EP 2.8V
EP 13.3V
PANEL 4.75V
PANEL -15.3V
CAM -7.5V
(2/2)
IC1301
DC/DC
CONV.
(4-73)
BT901
CAM 15V
D 1.5V
RP 6.0V
CN4001
Q4003
ACV URREG
CHARGE
SW
Q4002
SHOE/PRT UNREG
BATT SIG
17
CN304
LANC SIG
28
3
CN1103
LANC
FP-411(FLEXIBLE)(2/2)
(PAGE 4-13)
3-9
INIT CHARGE ON
SHOE ON
3-10
4
3
2
6
5
FAST CHARGE
BATT/EXT SW
BATT SIG
(PAGE 4-13)
CN301
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(3/5)
(PAGE 3-6)
BATT UNREG
XEJECT SW
SI-032 BOARD(2/2)
16
ZOOM VR AD
SIRCS PWM 89
88 IB SI
87 IB SO
I/F
7
8
CN1109
J303
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(4/5)
(PAGE 3-2)
RV001
ZOOM VR
SIRCS SIG 86
S002
START/STOP
SW
(PAGE 3-3)
XCC DOWN
REC PROOF
82 LANC IN
83 LANC OUT
10
12
(4-78)
CONTROL
SWITCH
BLOCK
(SS-1380)
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(2/5)
XCC DOWN 5
Q4801
PHOTO
SW
A17 A19
CAM DD ON 25
VTR DD ON 26
HI EVER SO
CN1106
S004
HI EVER SCK
S601
XCS MECHA 51
70 20MHz IN
99 32kHz IN
17
71
VDD
98
151
BATT LI 3V
CN002
11
INTELLIGENT
ACCESSORY
SHOE(2/2)
69 20MHz OUT
CONTROL SWITCH
BLOCK (CF-2500)(2/2) (PAGE 4-23)
CHARACTER
DISPLAY
X4802
32.768kHz
(4-77)
S023
KEY AD 1-4
RESET
20
CN1110
CN006
SEL/PUSH
EXEC
DIAL
16
19
KEY AD 0, 1
(PAGE 4-23)
CN5703
SHOE/PRT UNREG
HI CONTROL
VTR FUNCTION
SW
LCD902
LANC SIG
IC4801
S401, 403-409
S003~006,
009~010,
012~013,
015~019,
022~029
CN1101
(4-61)
Q4011
DC IN
+
S
BATTERY
TERMINAL
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
VC-272 BOARD(5/5)
(PAGE 4-23)
79 DIAL A
80 DIAL B
14
13
S007
4
12
10
9
7
12
11
FUNCTION
SW
KEY AD0
61
65
KEY AD4
66
X5001
10MHz
S001
(4-77)
OPEN/CLOSE
SW
IC4701
S023
RESET
CONTROL SWITCH
BLOCK (CF-2500)(2/2)
CHARACTER
DISPLAY
11
20
30
PANEL
REVERSE
SW
INDICATOR
DRIVE
(4-19)
CN5702
FP-412
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-19)
3
7
VTR UNREG
VDD SWITCH
IC4903
XCC DOWN
5
EEPROM
XTAL
52 32kHz OUT
TXD
23
24
SCK 25
CS 26
73 XRESET
14
53
62
VCC
SIRCS SIG 41
CN5704
7
19
10
16
21
20
18
22
(PAGE 4-27)
S003
OPEN/EJECT SW
EEP TXD
EEP RXD
EEP SCK
CS EEP
REC PROOF
REC PROOF 37
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(4/5)
HI SO 200
HI SI 201
207
206
205
124
190
191
185
134
TXD
CS MECHA 17
CS MECHA (IC4501)
RXD
SCK
CS
IR ON
IR ON 30
168 CAM DD ON
SIRCS PWM
HI EVER SO
LCD COM/XDATA
IC4703
39
40
LANC IN
LANC OUT
43
42
IB SI
IB SO
7
8
XPHOTO FREEZ
XS/S SW
11
KEY AD5
XPHOTO FREEZ
XS/S SW
XVTR MODE SW
XCAM MODE SW
XPHOTO STBY SW
LANC
I/O
10
12
I/F
1
4
3
1
2
7
XVTR MODE SW
XCAM MODE SW
XPHOTO STBY SW
BATT/EXT SW
FAST CHARGE
INIT CHARGE ON
SHOE ON
74
37
38
17
12
XEJECT SW
BL REG
USB 3.1V
D 1.9V
D 2.8V
AU 2.8V
(PAGE 3-2)
ZOOM VR AD
11
A 2.8V
A 4.75V
AU 4.75V
RP 4.75V
MT 5V
EP 4.75V
EP 2.8V
EP 13.3V
PANEL 4.75V
PANEL -15.3V
CAM -7.5V
(2/2)
DC/DC
CONV.
(4-73)
BT901
CAM 15V
D 1.5V
RP 6.0V
CN4001
Q4003
ACV URREG
Q4002
CHARGE
SW
INIT CHARGE ON
SHOE ON
SHOE/PRT UNREG
Q4010
CN301
17
CN304
LANC SIG
28
3
CN1103
LANC
FP-411(FLEXIBLE)(2/2)
(PAGE 4-13)
3-11
3-12
4
3
2
6
5
FAST CHARGE
BATT/EXT SW
BATT SIG
BATT SIG
(PAGE 4-13)
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(3/5)
IC1301
BATT UNREG
XEJECT SW
SI-032 BOARD(2/2)
16
TO
OVERALL
BLOCK(1/5)
(PAGE 3-6)
VTR DD ON 35
67 KEY AD5
BL CONT
CN1109
J303
(PAGE 3-7)
ZOOM VR AD
RV001
ZOOM VR
XCC DOWN
HI EVER SCK
S002
POWER
SW
(2/2)
SIRCS PWM 45
XOSD SCK
OSD SO
LCD COM/XDATA
XCS LCD DRIVER
CN005
Q5001
S001
SIRCS SIG
(4-78)
START/STOP
SW
18
INTELLIGENT
ACCESSORY
SHOE(2/2)
PD-160 BOARD(2/2)
CONTROL
SWITCH
BLOCK
(SS-1380)
9
1
CN1106
PHOTO
SW
17
BATT UNREG
(PAGE 4-23)
S004
29 XTAL
51 32kHz IN
CN5701
1
2
20
HI CONTROL
RXD
BATT LI 3V
3
BT001
LITHIUM
BATTERY
IC5701
CN5703
S601
X4802
32.768kHz
28
2
CN002
IC4901
59
KEY AD0-KEY AD4
KEY AD 1-4
RESET
19
CN1110
CN006
SEL/PUSH
EXEC
DIAL
KEY AD 0, 1
16
SHOE/PRT UNREG
HI CONTROL
VTR FUNCTION
SW
LCD902
LANC SIG
IC5001
S401, 403-409
S003~006,
009~010,
012~013,
015~019,
022~029
CN1101
(4-63)
DC IN
+
S
BATTERY
TERMINAL
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
(DCR-TRV340)
Q4010
F4005
F4006
BT901
17
18
SHOE/PRT UNREG
19
SWITCHING
5
1
(DCR-TRV240)
Q4001,
4002
F4001
Q4003,
4004
CHARGE
SWITCH
BATT GND
BATT UNREG
TO
POWER
BLOCK(3/3)
(PD-160)
(PAGE 3-17)
Q1311,1312,1327
C/D VS D1.5V
L4001
MT 5V
5V REG
BL REG UNREG
F4004
VTR UNREG
ACV UNREG
VTR UNREG
F4002
BATT/XEXT SW
SHOE ON
CN4001
BL CONT
INIT CHARGE ON
BL CONT
FAST CHARGE
SHOE ON
3
2
17
18
13
15
14
CN1106
BATT UNREG
F4003
DC IN
4
BL CONT
BL REG
PANEL 2.8V
PANEL 13.3V
PANEL 4.75V
Q4005,4007,4009
BATT UNREG
BATT SIG
VC-276 BOARD(1/3)
INTELLIGENT
ACCESSORY
SHOE
BATT SIG
(473)
INIT CHARGE ON
Q1309
SWITCHING
IC1301
L1317
L1318
VTR DD ON
BL REG
DC/DC CONVERTER
NONINV
7 INPUT7
31 STANDBY7
CAM DD ON
FAST CHARGE
OUTPUT7 2
OUTPUT
MONITOR-7 6
OUTPUT VCC7
OUTPUT VCC4,5,6
OUTPUT4
57
MOS GATE4
54
BATT/XEXT SW
Q1335,1337
L1305
L1310
D 1.5V
D 2.8V
IC1305
Q1308
SWITCHING
28 VCC
2
5
41
L1302
45
L1306
MOS GATE1
42
OUTPUT
MONITOR1
40
Q1307
SWITCHING
49
Q1301
SWITCHING
5
4
VREF
27 VREF
OUTPUT3
50
OUTPUT MONITOR3
34
7
8
3
Q1302
SWITCHING
22 CT
OUTPUT2
VTR DD ON
29 STANDBY3
30 STANDBY
OUTPUT
MONITOR2
D1302 (1/2)
RECT
2
21 RT
D 2.8V
L1307
A 2.8V
L1308
AU 2.8V
L1309
EP 2.8V
FB1301
EP 13.3V
Q1321,1323
15V REG
T1301
OUTPUT VCC1,2,3
EMERGENCY
DETECT
Q1333
IC1303
13.3V REG
2
5
D1306
RECT
D1302(2/2)
RECT
5.9V REG
RP 6.0V
(474)
Q1316,1329
-7.5V REG
L1313
L1301
46
AU 4.75V
L1314
A 4.75V
L1315
EP 4.75V
L1316
RP 4.75V
(429)
37
Q1305
SWITCHING
L1303
CAP VS
CAP VS
CAP ERROR
OUTPUT6
64
OUTPUT MONITOR6
10
NONINV INPUT6
11
DRUM VS
L1304
DRUM VS
TIMING
GENERATOR
CD-357
BOARD
FB1501
D 2.8V
OUTPUT5 58
A 4.75V
DRUM ERROR
CAM 15V
CAM -7.5V
IC551
10
12
CN1501
16
3-13
IC1501
DRUM ERROR
CAP ERROR
Q1306
SWITCHING
OUTPUT MONITOR5 14
NONINV INPUT5 15
TO
POWER
BLOCK(2/3)
(PAGE 3-15)
A 4.75V
Q1304
SWITCHING
Q1314
OUTPUT1
USB 3.1V
3.1V REG
OUTPUT
MONITOR4 18
COMP
D 1.9V
1.9V REG
Q1303
SWITCHING
CAM DD ON
20
CN1101
Q4011
BATTERY
TERMINAL
3-14
CCD
IMAGER
7
5
CN551
(48)
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
VC-276 BOARD(2/3)
A : DCR-TRV240
B : DCR-TRV340
S001
BATT LI3V
POWER
(4-61)
(4-63)
SHOE ON
BATT SIG
INIT CHARGE ON
VTR DD ON
CAM DD ON
FAST CHARGE
BATT XEXT SW
IB SO 87/42
IB SI 88/41
IC4701 (4-77)
D4702
BATT UNREG
3
2
BATTER IN
DETECT
REG
IC4703 (4-78)
80/31 BATT IN
4
8
LANC I/O
VTR UNREG
1 UNREG
LANC DC
14 LANC DC
XVTR MODE SW
1/1
XCAM MODE SW
2/2
FB7001
VCC 8
L5803
(4-61)
(4-67)
(4-66)
(4-65)
IC5701
IC5702
IC5801
AUDIO I/O
AUDIO
ADC&DAC
MIC AMP
AU 2.8V
(PAGE 3-14)
D 1.5V
IC4502
CN1110
(4-60)
S023
FB4502
FB3701
FB3370
L3307
FB3304
(4-10)
RESET
CN006
5
DISP LCD VDD
20
SW
CONTROL SWITCH
BLOCK (FK-2500)
TO
POWER
BLOCK
(3/3)
(PD-160)
DISP BL
21
CN005
(PAGE 4-23)
(PAGE 3-17)
FB4501
CAM DD ON
FB6003
L6001
FB2291
A/D CONV.
IC3701
IC3301
VIDEO
LINE IN/OUT
AMP
IC3303
DV
SIGNAL
PROCESS
DV
INTERFACE
(4-41)
(4-43)
IC6002
IC2291
AUDIO
A/D
CONV.
(EVR)
D/A CONV.
(4-49)
L3701,
3705
(4-48)
L2291
(4-56)
D 1.5V
USB 3.1V
FB6001
D 1.9V
USB
I/F
(4-70)
IC1552
TO
POWER
BLOCK(3/3)
IRIS DRIVE
LENS ASSY
(4-34)
(PAGE 3-18)
R1560
D 2.8V
IC6001
FB6002
A 4.75V
A 2.8V
MT 5V
D 1.5V
D 2.8V
R1132
20
2
(4-55)
27
L2001
17
1
LANC DC
A 4.75V
SE 2.8V
MT 5V
IRIS
METER
16
ZOOM
RESET
SENSOR
14
FOCUS
RESET
SENSOR
18
TEMP
17
CAPSTAN
FG
T REEL,
S REEL
SENSOR
Q1555
(4-33)
F LED 2.8V
24
IC1553
TO
POWER
BLOCK(3/3)
(SI-032)
ZOOM/
FOCUS
MOTOR
DRIVE
(PAGE 3-17)
CN1103
L2204
L2209
FB2202
FB2205
L2202
L2208
FB2204
CAP VS
FB1504
L1501
A 4.75V
L1553
MT 5V
L1551
(4-57)
DRUM VS
IC2201
IC1502
HI8/STD8
PB Y/C
PROCESS
S/H,AGC,
A/D CONV.
DRUM ERROR
(4-32)
FB1402
(4-30)
RP 4.75V
A 2.8V
RF 1.9V
L3102
L3201
L3104
L1401
IC2001
IC1401
PITCH/
YAW
SENSOR
AMP
CAMERA
PROCESS
MPEG MOVIE
PROCESS
DIGITAL
STILL PROCESS
(4-69)
L3103
IC3202
IC3103
IC3101
HI8/STD8
PB RF
AMP
RF ENV
DET
REC/PB
AMP
EQ.
A/D CONV.
PLL
(4-51)
(4-52)
(4-46)
(4-35)
(4-58)
IC1402
IC4401
SDRAM
(4-35)
IC3201
CN1551
IC4402
CAP VS
CAP ERROR
DRUM ERROR
29
CAP ERROR
27
DRUM VS
6
DRUM
MOTOR DRIVE
DRUM FG,PG AMP
LOADING
MOTOR DRIVE
REEL FG AMP
TAPE TOP,END DET
DRUM,CAP ERROR AMP
CAPSTAN MOTOR
DRIVE
2
1
CN4403
SENSOR VCC
R4407
H001,002
FB1403
D 2.8V
VTR UNREG
MT 5V
TAPE LED(A)
R4411
(4-45)
RP 6.0V
12
CN4404
D001
TAPE LED
M2100 MECHA
DECK
(SEE PAGE 4-25)
16
3-15
LCD
UNIT
BTOOI
LITHIUM
BATTERY
MECHA
CONTROL
CAMERA
CONTROL
EVF
BACKLIGHT
DRIVE
(DCR-TRV340)
L3602
IC3603
RP 4.75V
(PAGE 4-23)
Q1104, 1105
FB3301
8
7
1
CN702
16
18
CN701
11
USB 3.1V
D 2.8V
5
3
CN002
EVER 3.0V
A 4.75V
LCD903
IC701
IC4501
EEPROM
EEPROM
LB-076 BOARD
CN7001
(4-53)
(DCR-TRV240)
A 2.8V
AU 2.8V
D 2.8V
FB3601
(4-60)
IC4802
L5701
TO
POWER BLOCK
(1/3)
LCE DRIVE
AU 4.75V
D 1.9V
A 2.8V
TIMING
GENERATOR
(4-53)
L7001
3
EP 2.8V
EP 13.3V
EP 4.75V
USB 3.1V
IC7001
FB7002
D 2.8V
VTR UNREG
MT 5V
AU 2.8V
CAMERA
IC7002
EP 4.75V
EP 13.3V
EP 2.8V
92/46 XLANC ON
XPHOTO STBY SW 7/7
VTR DD
114/56 SENSE
LCD LED ON 175/12
Q4701
POWER 4
OFF(CHG)
MEMORY (DCR-TRV340)
17 71 98 VDD/
151/14 53
VCC
62
D 4703
MT 5V
67/73 XRESET
RESET
Q4801/Q5001
BATT SIG
I/F
ZOOM VR
XVTR MODE SW
XCAM MODE SW
XPHOTO STBY SW
1
4
3
SHOE ON 21/17
112/54 BATT SENS
113/55 ACV SENS
D 2.8V
10
HI CONTROL
VCR
RV001
CN1109
IC4801 / IC5001
3-16
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
( ) : Page No. shown in ( ) indicates the page to refer on the schematic diagram.
PD-160
BOARD
Q5505,5506
PANEL 13.3V
FB5504
18
FB5502
PANEL 2.8V
Q1101,1102
16
D5503
VCC
2.5
LCD
UNIT
FB1102
CN1105
MS VCC ON
CN5501
L5501
23
IC5501
IC5502
RGB DRIVE
14
TIMING
GENERATOR
(4-21)
IC4901
CAM DD ON
(4-21)
TO
POWER
BLOCK (2/3)
(PAGE 3-16)
D 1.9V
168
L4901
(4-38)
HI CONTROL,
DIGITAL STILL
CONTROL
IC4903
IC4907
IC4905
(4-37)
(4-37)
(4-37)
EEPROM
BUFFER
XTAL
OSC
CN5701
PANEL 4.75V
14
16
PANEL 13.3V
15
PANEL 2.8V
13
D 1.5V
FB4902
D 2.8V
FB4903
FB5101
TO
POWER BLOCK
(1/3)
(VC-276)
(PAGE 3-14)
ND901
BACKLIGHT
(4-20)
IC5601,5602
INVERTER
17
18
BL CONT
BL REG
BL HIGH
BACKLIGHT
DRIVE
IC5101
IC5102
SDRAM
16Mbit
FLASH
MEMORY
16Mbit
(4-39)
(4-40)
10
CN5601
(4-19)
(DCR-TRV340)
IC5701
TO
POWER
BLOCK(2/3)
(CF-2500)
(PAGE 3-16)
INDICATOR
DIRVE
D902
BL VDD
DISP BL
CN5704
CN5705
CHARACTER
DISPLAY
BACKLIGHT
SI-032 BOARD
D301,D302
30
MT 5V
NIGHT SHOT
LED
D306
11
F LED 2.8V
TALLY LED
SE301,302
TO
POWER BLOCK
(2/3)
(VC-276)
14
(PAGE 3-16)
29
4
SE 2.8V
PITCH/YAW
SENSOR
LANC DC
IC301
A 4.75V
REMOTE
COMMANDER
RECEIVER
CN304
16
R301
(4-14)
CN301
3
MF PHOTO
SENSOR
15
FP-411
J303
(FLEXIBLE)
(PAGE 4-13)
3-17
LANC
3-18E
MEMORY
STICK
SLOT
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SECTION 4
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
4-1. FRAME SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM (1/2)
7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
INTELLIGENT
ACCESSORY
SHOE
CD-357 BOARD
15P
A
LENS UNIT
GND
V1
V2
V3
V4
14
15
16
GND
MIC_L
SHOE_CONT_AD
MIC_GND
CTS
MT_GND
15
14
13
12
STB_ON
SHOE_ID1
5
11
TXD
4
RTS
LANC
3
HEAD_UNREG
2
10
SHOE_UNREG
1
H2
RG
GND
13
CAM_15V
H1
VSHT
12
CAM-7.5
11
GND
10
CCD_OUT
GND
GND
CN551
16P
CCD
IMAGER
SHOE_ID2
RXD
FP-264
S_C_I/O
REG_GND
S_Y_I/O
S_GND
AUDIO_R_I/O
REG_GND
VIDEO_I/O
10
REG_GND
11
AUDIO_L_I/O
12
AV_JACK_IN
13
REG_GND
AUDIO/VIDEO
SHOE_MT_GND
SHOE_MT_GND
20
3
SHOE_UNREG_GND
20P
SHOE/PRT_UNREG
2
SHOE_UNREG_GND
19
1
SHOE_UNREG_GND
CN1101
SHOE/PRT_UNREG
16
GND
18
15
GND
PRT_HEAD_UNREG
14
CCD_OUT
17
13
GND
PRT_HEAD_UNREG
12
CAM-7.5
16
11
VSHT
LANC_SIG
10
CAM_15V
RF_SWP
N.C
S002
C1109
VCO
11
EVF_VG
12
RF_SWP
13
12P
START/STOP
XVTR_MODE_SW
REG_GND
XPHOTO_STBY_SW
XCAM_MODE_SW
(FOR CHECK)
XS/S_SW
REG_GND
KEY_AD5
S004
PHOTO
D4901
(ACCESS)
14
CAP_FG
15
RF_MON
16
N.C
17
REG_GND
18
REG_GND
19
REG_GND
20
S003
OPEN/EJECT
CPC
10
(DCR-TRV340)
REG_GND
D_2.8V
10
ZOOM_VR
11
XEJECT_SW
12
(PHOTO FREEZE)
RV001
ZOOM
W
T
S001
POWER
VCR
MT_5V
1
LANC_SIG
LANC_DC
2
XLANC_JACK_IN
4
LIA1
5
VREF1
6
LIA2
7
VREF2
SE_GND
9
HP_GND
10
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
REG_GND
REG_GND
XF_TALLY_LED
F_LED_2.8V
SIRCS_SIG
IR_ON/SIRCS_PWM
SE_2.8V
HP_JACK_IN
INT_MIC_L
INT_MIC_R
INT_MIC_GND
HP_L
HP_R
HP_GND
SE_GND
VREF2
LIA2
VREF1
LIA1
XLANC_JACK_IN
LANC_SIG
LANC_DC
MT_5V
5
EXT_MIC_GND
4
A_4.75V
3
MF_B
EXT_MIC_L
2
MF_LED
FLEXIBLE
EXT_MIC_R
1
MF_A
30P
MEMORY STICK
CONNECTOR
HP_R
INT_MIC_L
15
FP-406
FLEXIBLE
11
IR_ON/SIRCS_PWM
HP_JACK_IN
16
SIRCS_SIG
SE_2.8V
EXT_MIC_GND
26
17
A_4.75V
27
F_LED_2.8V
MF_B
28
(DCR-TRV340)
18
MF_LED
29
19
MF_A
30
20
VSS
VCC
8
VSS
SCLK
7
INS
6
FP-409
I
15
9
GND
MEMORY
10
DIO
5
TXD
8
H2
14
7
H1
SHOE_ID1
6
RG
13
RXD
4
V1
12
3
V2
GND
SHOE_ID2
2
V3
11
1
V4
RTS t SCK
10
FOCUS_XA
STB_ON
FOCUS_XB
N.C
CAMERA
XF_TALLY_LED
D-
21
REG_GND
REG_GND
23
24
VCC
FOCUS_B
REG_GND
OFF(CHG)
BS
NTPB
REG_GND
D+
21
22
VSS
TPB
VCC
TPA
NTPA
20
22
REG_GND
REG_GND
REG_GND
19
23
18
EXT_MIC_L
ID
EXT_MIC_R
D+
24
NTPA
25
TPA
17
VSS
DV
IN/OUT
CTS t HDS
FOCUS_A
30P
16
4P
PB_RF
N.C
CN1103
D-
SHOE_MIC_GND
IR_SWITCH
N.C
XPHOTO_FREEZE
CN202
TPB
VCC
GND
15
CN1105
(USB)
IR_SWITCH
BPF_MONI
NTPB
10P
5P
ZOOM_XA
N.C
N.C
CN203
SHOE_MIC_L
10
ZOOM_B
ZOOM_XB
REG_GND
HP_L
14
TO
VC-276 BOARD(2/2)
FH(2/2)
20P
USB BLOCK
MD BLOCK
CAM/MECHA CONT. BLOCK
HI-1 BLOCK
HI-2 BLOCK
AU BLOCK
MA BLOCK
SE,ER BLOCK
FU BLOCK
DD BLOCK
CN BLOCK
LANC/RESET/BEEP,CN BLOCK
12
14/25
15/25
16/25
17/25
18/25
19/25
20/25
21/25
22/25
23/25
24/25
25/25
INT_MIC_R
S VIDEO
S_GND
CN1108
VC-276 BOARD(1/2)
INT_MIC_GND
24P
13
J201
XS_JACK_IN
14
FLEXIBLE
1
2
SHOE_CONT_AD
11
16P
12
N.C.
16
ZOOM_A
17
ZM_SENSE_VCC
ZM_SENSE_OUT
18
TEMP
15
19
TEMP
13
20
IRIS_DRIVE(-)
14
21
IRIS_BIAS(-)
FC_SENSE_OUT
22
IRIS_HALL(-)
FC_SENSE_VCC
23
IRIS_BIAS(+)
CN1104
FP-410
FLEXIBLE
CN1501
FLEXIBLE
GND
24
IRIS_HALL(+)
CN1551
24P
IRIS_DRIVE(+)
FP-161
CN304
(DCR-TRV340)
CN301
SI-032 BOARD
MIC901
L-CH
MIC
K
MIC901
R-CH
MIC
CN302
1
INT_MIC_L
GND
INT_MIC_R
GND
4P
D301,302
(IR EMITTER)
IC301
(REMOTE COMANDER)
D306
(TALLY)
SE302
SE301
YAW
SENSOR
PITCH
SENSOR
18P
REG_GND
18
LANC_SIG
17
XLANC_JACK_IN
16
LANC_DC
15
HP_GND
14
HP_R
13
HP_L
12
HP_JACK_IN
11
EXT_MIC_R
10
EXT_MIC_L
MIC_GND
MIC_GND
REG_GND
MF_B
J301
(HEADPHONES)
FP-411
FLEXIBLE
J302
MIC
(PLUG IN POWER)
J303
MF_LED
MF_4.75V
REG_GND
MF_A
LANC
16
4-1
4-2
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
10
11
12
14
13
15
16
17
18
19
ND901
BACK LIGHT
LCD901
2.5INCH
S005,013,017,018,026,028,029
MPEG
MEMORY PLAY/
KEY_AD0
PAUSE
MEMORY MIX
5P
S401,403-409
REC/
REW/
REG_GND
SEIDEN_GND
CN005
6P
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
LCD_COM/XDATA
CN5704
HARNESS
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
LCD_COM/XDATA
OSD_SO
OSD_SO
XOSD_SCK
XOSD_SCK
DISP_LCD_VDD
DISP_LCD_VDD
DISP_BL
DISP_BL
23
22
21
24
TEST1
VST
COM
VCK
10
SEG10
11
SEG1
12
SEG11
13
SEG12
14
SEG13
15
SEG14
16
SEG16
17
SEG15
18
COM3
19
COM4
20
PSIG
VR
MAKER_CHECK
GND
GND
PANEL_13.3V
PANEL_4.75V
PANEL_2.8V
REG_GND
VD_SCK
XCS_LCD
VD_SO
PANEL_XVD
PANEL_XHD
PANEL_HOLD
PANEL_B
PANEL_G
PANEL_R
XPANEL_REV
XRST_VTR
13
12
11
10
BL_CONT
17
14
BL_REG
18
PANEL_-15.3V
BL_GND
19
15
SE_GND
TAPE_LED(A)
TAPE_LED(K)
TAPE_END(C)
TAPE_TOP(C)
13
14
15
N.C.
N.C.
GND
GND
CN701
20P
FLEXIBLE
S601
2
3
LED_ON/OFF
VCK
16
EVF_4.75V
STB
15
D_2.8V
EN
14
COM
DWN
13
VG
RGT
12
VR
HST
11
VB
HCK2
10
HCK1
11
BLK
12
VB
13
VR
14
VG
15
COM
16
LED_DA
19
LED_DA
EVF_VDD
18
EVF_VDD
LED_ON/OFF
17
EVF_4.75V
D_2.8V
COM
VG
8
9
D701
VR
VB
10
GND
11
10
GND
GND
12
GND
BLK
13
BLK
HCK1
HCK2
HST
Q001
TAPE TOP
SENSOR
15
HST
16
S001
REC PROOF
ME/MP
Hi8 MP
S901
MODE
SWITCH
S002
C.C.LOCK
CN4001
H001,002
T REEL SENSOR
S REEL SENSOR
EN
17
EN
STB
18
STB
VCK
19
VCK
VST
20
VST
BACK
LIGHT
D702
(TALLY)
FP-301
FP-302
FLEXIBLE
FLEXIBLE
6P
BATT_GND
BATT/XEXT
2
BT901
ACV_GND
ACV_UNREG
BATT_SIG
BATT_UNREG
Q002
TAPE END
SENSOR
4-4
16P
1
XTALLY_LED
14
CN702
VST
20
HCK1
LB-076
BOARD
VSS
HCK2
20P
VDD
XTALLY_LED
LS-057 BOARD
TAPE LED
4-3
2
3
CN7001
D001
FP-412
PANEL_REV
(PANEL REVERSE)
TAPE_TOP(C)
2
TAPE_END(C)
3
TAPE_LED(K)
TAPE_LED(A)
5
REG_GND
6
S_REEL(-)
S_REEL(+)
8
SENSOR_VCC
10
T_REEL(-)
T_REEL(+)
11
13
12
ME/MP
HALL_COM
REC_PROOF
15
14
HI8_MP
2
A
DEW
3
B
4
C
Vcc
Vo1
7
Vo2
8
GND(COM)
9
Coil-U
10
Coil-U
11
Coil-V
C_LOCK_SW
FP-300
FLEXIBLE
FLEXIBLE
FLEXIBLE
DEW
SENSOR
MR
SENSOR
FP-299
FP-228
SP2
PANEL_REV
XRST_VTR
XPANEL_REV
3
PANEL_R
5
PANEL_B
PANEL_G
6
PANEL_HOLD
8
PANEL_XVD
PANEL_XHD
9
VD_SO
10
11
VD_SCK
XCS_LCD
12
REG_GND
14
13
PANEL_2.8V
PANEL_4.75V
15
16
17
BL_CONT
PANEL_13.3V
PANEL_-15.3V
18
BL_REG
19
BL_GND
20
SE_GND
20P
VIDEO
HEAD
M902
M CAPSTAN
6P
CN1106
REG_GND
12
SENSOR_VCC
8
S_REEL(-)
T_REEL(+)
7
S_REEL(+)
T_REEL(-)
6
11
HALL_COM
5
ME/MP
4
10
REC_PROOF
3
15P
HI8_MP
2
CN4404
C_LOCK_SW
1
M-SW(A)
M-SW(B)
M-SW(C)
FG1
FG VCC
DEW
22
21
20
19
18
17
FG2
16
REG_GND
15
CAP_U
14
CAP_U
13
CAP_W
12
CAP_W
11
12
coil-V
13
Coil-W
14
Coil-W
15
VH+
16
Hu1
17
Hu2
19
18
Hv1
Hv2
20
Hw1
21
Hw2
22
VH-
11
FE(X)
10
FE(Y)
9
GND
8
SP2(Y)
HARNESS
FP
MOTOR
FE
BACK
LIGHT
XHD_OUT
10
16
(VP-076)
D902
LCD902
CHARACTER
DISPLAY
XHD
CN4401
FG
M901
DRUM
MOTOR
SP1
20
19
18
SEG9
VG
22
20
19
21
REG_GND
DISP_BL
EVER_3.0V
18
XOSD_SCK
16
15
17
OSD_SO
CAP_V
10
CAP_V
9
VH+
8
Hu1
7
Hv1
Hv2
Hu2
6
Hw1
3
Hw2
2
VH-
22P
CN4403
1
FE(X)
11
FE(Y)
10
GND
9
YEVEN(SP2Y)
8
GND
YODD(SP1Y)
XODD(SP1X)
GND
11P
CN3101
XEVEN(SP2X)
7
7
FP
SP2(X)
6
GND
3
GND
SP1(Y)
SP1(X)
2
GND
GND
10
U
8
V
7
V
5
W
FG
COM
1
PG
FG-PG_COM
GND
GND
2
COM
U
9
10
FG
10P
CN4402
FG-PG_COM
PG
1
2P
LM(+)
2
CN4401
LM(-)
1
1
FP
2P
LM(-)
FP
16
EN
(FOR CHECK)
FLEXIBLE
20P
10P
CN5702
LM(+)
DWN
SEG8
VC-276 BOARD(2/2)
M903
LOADING
MOTOR
17
SEG7
PD-117
VDD
SEG2
CPC
20
LCD_COM/XDATA
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
13
12
14
KEY_AD2
DIAL_A
DIAL_B
KEY_AD1
11
10
D_2.8V
KEY_AD2
KEY_AD3
D_2.8V
KEY_AD4
XHI_RESET
KEY_AD0
REG_GND
SP_-
SP_+
BATT_LI_3V
CN1110
22P
TO
VC-276
BOARD(1/2)
FH(1/2)
FG/PG
16
SEG6
3
4
VSS
SEG5
XVD_OUT
VDOG
SEG4
PD-160 BOARD
6P
VVSSG
CS
HST
WIDE
REF
SOUT
CRext
HCK2
PSIG
HCK1
RGT
TEST2
N.C.
BL_HIGH
SEG3
FP-414
VB
PD-117
(CP-076)
(LITHIUM BATTERY)
15
14
13
12
11
10
10
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
LED
BL_LOW
COM2
CN5502
SEL/PUSH EXEC
PLAY
COM1
CN5703
(DCR-TRV340)
BT001
S007
FLEXIBLE
D2.8V
BL_VDD
FP-407
BL_VDD
MEMORY(+)/
MEMORY(-)/
BL_GND
24P
SP(+)
BL_GND
CN5501
4P
20P
SP(-)
CN5705
CN5701
EXPOSURE
10P
SP901
SPEAKER
S001
(OPEN/CLOSE)
2P
CN5601
CN004
FOCUS/ PB ZOOM/
BACK LIGHT/
DISPLAY/ VOLUME -/
RESET/ EDITSEARCH+/ -/
LED_GND
TITLE/
S003,004,006,009,010,012,015
016,019,022-025,027
END SEARCH/
BATTERY
TERMINAL
LCD903
B/W EVF
UNIT
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
6 5 4
4 5 6
1 2 3
3 2 1
3 2 1
5 4 3
Voltages and waveforms are measured between the measurement points and ground when camera shoots color bar chart of
pattern box. They are reference values and reference waveforms. *
(VOM of DC 10 M input impedance is used.).
Voltage values change depending upon input impedance of VOM
used.) *
2
1. Connection
Pattern box
B
1.5 m
Kinds of capacitor
Temperature characteristics
External dimensions (mm)
Red
Blue
Yellow
White
Magenta
A=B
B A
Yellow
Cyan
Green
White
Magenta
Red
Blue
Note :
The components identified by
mark 0 or dotted line with mark
0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number
specified.
A B
Cyan
Green
Electron beam
scanned frame
CRT picture frame
4-5
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
CD-357 BOARD
CCD IMAGER
LND551
GND
XX MARK:NO MOUNT
GND
CCD_OUT
GND
GND
D551
MA111-(K8).S0
FB552
0uH
C561
0.01u
B
R-0.3/P0
C552
10u
20V
TA
B
C554
XX
GND
13
12
11
10
R14.8/0
Q551
2SC4178-F13F14-T1
BUFFER
C562
XX
B
R558
1M
C556
33u
10V
TA B
R569
0
L552
100uH
CCD_OUT
R-0.3/P0
V2
V1
V3
R-7.1/P0
V4
14
VDD
RG/NC
CAM-7.5
R557
100k
R14.8
/P0
R12.5
/P0
VSHT
SUB
R563 0
GND
CAM_15V
7
VL
R9.2
/P0
10
H2
R-7.5
/P0.4
H1
R566
XX
11
R9.5/
P0
5
H1/RG
RG
R12.5
/P0
12
R567 0
(PAGE 4-29
of LEVEL3)
13
H2/H1
V1
GND
CCD IMAGER
R1.6
/P0
4 3 2 1
14
ICX281BKA-13
8
5
15
C557
XX
R568
0
OPEN/H2
TO
VC-276 BOARD(1/25)
CN1501
THROUGH THE
FP-161 FLEXIBLE
V3
V2
IC551
IC551
16
R1.3
/P0
V4
R565
XX
16P
R564 0
CN551
R-7.1/P0
NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R :REC MODE
P :PB MODE
GND/NC
C560
0.1u
F
R9.5
/P0
R8.8/P0
R551
82
R553
3300
SIGNAL PATH
Precautions Upon Replacing CCD imager
VIDEO SIGNAL
CHROMA
REC
PB
If the CCD imager has been replaced, carry out all the
adjustments for the camera section.
As the CCD imager may be damaged by static electricity from
Transistor
G
E
CCD IMAGER
CD-357
4-7
4-8
Y/CHROMA
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
EVF,BACKLIGHT
NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
63
2.8
IC701
NJM2125F(TE2)
0.2
VCC
4.7
TO
VC-276 BOARD(13/25)
CN7001
THROUGH THE
FP-407 FLEXIBLE
(PAGE 4-54
of LEVEL3)
20P
XTALLY_LED
20
LED_DA
19
0.8
D702
SML-310LTT
(TALLY)
D701
NSCW100-T38
BACKLIGHT
R703
3300
BUFFER
4.7
R702
180k
0.5%
R706
33k
IC701
0
1
CN701
46
1.7
2
0.1
0.2
0.8
3
R701
33k
0.5%
Q701
UP04601008S0
LED DRIVE
0.1
R704
22
0.5%
EVF_VDD
18
LED_ON/OFF
17
EVF_4.75V
16
D_2.8V
15
COM
14
16
COM
VG
13
15
VG
VR
12
14
VR
VB
11
13
VB
GND
10
12
BLK
GND
11
HCK1
BLK
10
HCK2
HCK1
HST
HCK2
RGT
HST
DWN
EN
R707
6800
CN702
SIGNAL PATH
16P
VIDEO SIGNAL
CHROMA
16
EN
STB
STB
VCK
VCK
VST
VST
VSS
VDD
C702
2.2u
F
2012
Y/CHROMA
REC
LCD903
4.7
Q702
UP04312008S0
LED SWITCH
LB-076 BOARD
A
PB
B/W
EVF UNIT
1 2 3
4-9
4-10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
FP-411 FLEXIBLE
PH302
PH301
J302
MIC
(PLUG IN POWER)
J301
(HEADPHONES)
J303
LANC
21
18
Diode
/ FP-411 FLEXIBLE
4-12
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
10
12
11
13
14
SI-032 BOARD
STEADY SHOT,LASER LINK
NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
FP-411
FLEXIBLE
CN301
J303
18P
REG_GND
18
LANC_SIG
17
XLANC_JACK_IN
16
LANC_DC
15
HP_GND
14
HP_R
13
HP_L
12
HP_JACK_IN
11
EXT_MIC_R
10
EXT_MIC_L
MIC_GND
(LANC)
B
J301
(HEADPHONES)
J302
MIC
(PLUG IN POWER)
LND019
SEDEN_GND
MIC_GND
REG_GND
MF_B
MF_LED
MF_4.75V
REG_GND
PH302
FPI-222N1
MF_A
LANC_SIG
R316 470
XLANC_JACK_IN
LANC_DC
HP_GND
HP_R
HP_L
HP_JACK_IN
EXT_MIC_R
EXT_MIC_L
C314
6800p
B
1608
C315
6800p
B
1608
MF_B
MF_LED
CN304
R301
120
LANC_DC
MF_A
LANC_SIG
PH301
FPI-222N1
VDR301
VDR302
XLANC_JACK_IN
D304
UDZSTE-178.2B
VDR303
R307
0
CH_GND
D309
01ZA8.2(TPL3)
LND301
D313
01ZA8.2(TPL3)
HP_GND
HP_R
D303
01ZA8.2(TPL3)
HP_L
FB301
0uH
HP_JACK_IN
2.8V
LIA1
Vref1
SE301
PITCH SENSER
2
D306
SML-310LTT86
(TALLY)
GND
C310
0.1u
B
EXT_MIC_R
EXT_MIC_L
C309
XX
B
C311
22u
4V
TA A
MF_B
MF_LED
C305
0.1u
B
IC301
LIA2
4.7
C313
XX
B
C312
22u
4V
A
MIC901
MIC UNIT
CN302
MIC
L
MIC
R
16
D301
CL-310IRS-X-TU
(IR EMITTER)
LANC_DC
28
LANC_SIG
27
XLANC_JACK_IN
26
LIA1
25
VREF1
24
LIA2
23
VREF2
22
SE_GND
21
HP_GND
20
HP_R
19
HP_L
18
INT_MIC_GND
17
INT_MIC_R
16
INT_MIC_L
15
HP_JACK_IN
14
SE_2.8V
13
IR_ON/SIRCS_PWM
12
SIRCS_SIG
11
F_LED_2.8V
10
XF_TALLY_LED
REG_GND
REG_GND
EXT_MIC_R
EXT_MIC_L
EXT_MIC_GND
A_4.75V
MF_B
MF_LED
MF_A
TO
VC-276 BOARD(24/25)
CN1103
THROUGH THE
FP-406 FLEXIBLE
(PAGE 4-76
of LEVEL3)
D312
XX
AUDIO
SIGNAL
R OUT
GND
REC
D302
CL-310IRS-X-TU
(IR EMITTER)
VCC
D311
XX
D310
XX
4P
R321
XX
4.4
IC301
NJL61H400A
SE302
YAW SENSER
29
30P
SIGNAL PATH
RECIEVER
GND
2.8V
Vref2
R320
56
1/10W
2012
R319
56
1/10W
2012
MT_5V
REMOTE COMMANDER
FB302
0uH
1
MF_A
30
3.9
PB
Q301
2SD1938(F)-S(TX).SO
LED DRIVE
0.2
INT_MIC_L
GND
2
3
INT_MIC_R
GND
4-13
4-14
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
PD-160 (CHA, DISPLAY DRIVE, BACK LIGHT, LCD DRIVE, TG) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
4
5
7
8
10
Transistor
C
6 5 4
1 2 3
4-16
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
FP-412 FLEXIBLE
6
S601
(PANEL REVERSE)
22
4-17
/ FP-412 FLEXIBLE
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
10
11
13
12
PD-160 BOARD(1/2)
CHA.DISPLAY DRIVE,BACK LIGHT(LCD/BL BLOCK)
CN5701
20P
B
TO
VC-276 BOARD
(24/25)
CN1106
SE_GND
20
BL_GND
19
BL_REG
18
BL_CONT
17
PANEL_-15.3V
16
PANEL_13.3V
15
PANEL_4.75V
14
PANEL_2.8V
13
PANEL_2.8V
REG_GND
12
REG_GND
11
XVC_SCK
L5602
4.7uH
R5613
XX
PANEL_13.3V
5
XCS_PANEL
XCS_LCD
10
VD_SO
XVC_SO
PANEL_XVD
XVD
PANEL_XHD
PANEL_HOLD
PANEL_B
SYNC
5
PANEL_B
PANEL_G
PANEL_G
PANEL_R
PANEL_R
XPANEL_REV
XRST_VTR
5.1
12
CN5601
4
-0.6
25
Q5604
XX
10
T5601
C5608
XX
46
INVERTER
TRANSFORMER
Q5602
TPC6C01(TE85R)
IC5602
FP-412
2.8
VCC
LND007
R5619
XX
6P
PANEL_REV
PANEL_REV
2
3
S601
(PANEL REVERSE)
N.C.
GND
GND
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
BL_LOW
LED
LED_GND
10P
ND901
BACK LIGHT
2
1
SIGNAL PATH
4
D5601
MA111-(K8).S0
1.7
C5605
0.1u
B
R5621
XX
D5603
XX
LND705
N.C.
CH_GND
SE_GND
BL_HIGH
0.4
2.8
4
CN5702
10
CURRENT DETECT
D5605
XX
63
R5611
180k
IC5602
TA75S393F-TE85R
D5602
XX
R5616
XX
Q5603
XX
LED DRIVE
XSYS_RST
R5702
XX
C5607
12p
SL
OSC
TO(2/2)
5.1
2
C5604
0.015u
B
VD_SCK
(PAGE 4-76
of LEVEL3)
R5610
1800
1/10W
THROUGH THE
VP-076 HARNESS
FLEXIBLE
L5601
100uH
C5602
4.7u
B
XX MARK:NO MOUNT
NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
-0.6
R5617
22k
VIDEO SIGNAL
C5606
0.1u
B
R5612
22k
CHROMA
Y/CHROMA
REC
R5618
470
PB
R5620
XX
R5609
10k
D5604
XX
IC5601
TC7W53FU(TE12R)
2.8
COM
VCC
INH
CH0
1.8
1
1.8
GND
CH1
VEE
Q5601
DTC144EHT2L
SWITCH
TO(2/2)
2.8
BL_ON
IC5601
BACK LIGHT
BRIGHT SWITCH
DAC
FP-414
LED
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
COM2
SEG3
SEG4
XOSD_SCK
DISP_LCD_VDD
1
3
SO
C5701
0.1u
B
SCK
VSS
3.0
SCK
3.0
VLCD
VDD
SO
0.7
SEG11
SEG13
SEG14
SEG15
SEG12
SEG9
SEG8
CHARACTOR
DISPLAY DRIVER
IC5701
BU9735K-E2
VC
3.0
3.0
DISP_BL
SEG16
SEG10
IC5701
10
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SCK
SEG4
SD
SEG3
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
OSC2
OSD_SO
OSC1
2.0
XCS
C/XD
LCD_COM/XDATA
1.5
(PAGE 4-23)
6P
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
SEG2
CN5704
TO
CONTROL
SWITCH BLOCK
(CF-2500)
CN005
THROUGH THE
CP-076 HARNESS
SEG6
SEG5
SEG7
R5704
680k
SEG17
SEG18
32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25
1.5
SEG10
SEG8
1.5
SEG9
SEG9
1.5
SEG8
SEG10
1.5
SEG7
SEG1
1.5
SEG6
SEG11
1.5
SEG5
SEG12
1.5
SEG4
SEG13
1.5
SEG3
SEG14
SEG16
COM4
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
COM3
SEG2
SEG1
COM4
COM3
COM2
C/XD
1.5
XCS
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
0
2.9
XCS
16
COM1
SEG15
4-19
SEG2
SEG1
COM4
COM3
COM2
COM1
C/XD
4-20
FLEXIBLE
BL_GND
BL_GND
D902
BL_VDD
BACK
LIGHT
BL_VDD
COM1
COM2
CN5703
COM1
4P
SEG11
SEG12
SEG13
SEG14
SEG15
CN5705
SEG16
Note :
Les composants identifis par
une marque 0 sont critiques
pour la scurit.
Ne les remplacer que par une
pice portant le numro spcifi.
R5614
10k
2.8
DETIN
Note :
The components identified by
mark 0 or dotted line with mark
0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number
specified.
SEG3
SEG4
SEG5
SEG6
SEG2
SEG7
SEG8
10
SEG9
11
SEG10
12
SEG1
13
SEG11
14
SEG12
15
SEG13
16
SEG14
17
SEG16
18
SEG15
19
COM3
20
COM4
20P
LCD902
CHARACTER
DISPLAY
UNIT
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
10
11
12
13
14
15
PD-160 BOARD(2/2)
A
L5504
XX
2520
FRP
C5510
0.01u
B
R5505
XX
VP
VG
VR
VB
VP
C5509
3.3u
25V
PFRP
BLK
FB5504
0uH
1608
PRG
BGP
PANEL_13.3V
CN5502
VB
XVD_OUT
VG
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
13.4
1.7
7.1
2.8
1.4
1.4
2.8
2.7
1.8
0.7
C5532
1u
B 2012
27
26
VR
25
Vcc2
P_DC_DET
R_IN
10
11
23
22
21
20
24
TEST1
23
COM
22
VST
21
VCK
20
EN
19
DWN
18
VDD
D5503
RD3.3UM-T1B
17
VSS
16
VDOG
C5534
1u
B
2012
15
VVSSG
14
CS
13
WIDE
12
HST
11
REF
10
SOUT
CRext
HCK2
HCK1
PSIG
RGT
TEST2
C5538
0.01u
B
Q5506
DTC144EHT2L
LCD SWITCH
13.4
RB5502
100KX4
C5540
0.1u
B
1608
R5588
XX
C5533
4.7u
B
3216
12
CN5501
TG24
D5502
1SV290(TPL3)
TG22
C5515
0.001u
B
R5511
1M
R5509
22k
TG23
R5512
100k
TG21
C5511
560p
SH4
SH3
FB5502
0uH
SH2
SH1
R5506
2700
C5512
0.1u
B
R5508
68k
R5507
47k
C5516
82p
R5510
68k
L5505
27uH
REG_GND
XP.SAVE
XC.SAVE
SH4
SH3
SH1
C5529
XX
SH2
TG20
R5591
XX
TG18
R5504
XX
TG17
TG16
XSYS_RST
1.4
2.5
XVC_SCK
XSCK
VDD
1.4
2.8
XSTBY
XC.SAVE
VST
24
PFRP
TG15
VCK
TG24
1.4
TG23
EN
DWN
IC5502
WIDE
Timing Generator
VDD
2.5
TG22
TG21
0.2
TG20
TST0
LED
PWM
TEST
TEST
TEST
10
11
12
2.6
18
17
16
15
14
13
R5574
820k
13.4
1.0
2
7.0
7.6
3
7.0
C5536
0.1u
B
R5575
68k
Q5504
2SA1774HT2L
LEVEL SHIFT
R5572
10k
2.8
0
TG18
1.4
TG17
TG16
TG15
2.8
TG14
SIGNAL PATH
2
1.4
7.0
6.4
13.4
64
VIDEO SIGNAL
7.0
CHROMA
Q5508
UP04601008S0
SWITCH
Y/CHROMA
REC
PB
XHD_OUT
SYNC
XVD_OUT
POFF
TSTEN
R5576
1M
GND
2.9
SYNC
2.8
DETIN
9
BL_ON
XVD
RGT
XWRT
VDO
HCK1
0.3
44
SI
HCK2
HDO
2.7
HST
HD
XVD
45
2.0
46
XVC_SO
SO
47
2.2
XTG_SO
IC5502
CXD3512R-T4
XCS
48
2.7
LCD901
2.5INCH
1.6
46
6.4
2.8
C5504
0.01u
B
XCS_PANEL
R5573
10k
Q5503
UP04601008S0
SWITCH
7.6
23
FRP
24P
25
22
SBLK
26
21
1.4
PRG
27
20
FRP
XCLP
1.4
28
OSCI
29
OSCO
2.8
1.4
30
RPD
2.8
VSS
SHA
31
TEST
0.5
2.8
32
SHB
SHG
33
19
BLK
PFRP
34
SHR
XCLR
2.8
37
2.7
PRG
38
BGP
Q5501
XX
No Mt
39
35
XVC_SCK
XCS_PANEL
40
XCS_PANEL
XVC_SO
C5508
XX
41
XVC_SCK
R5560
XX
42
XVC_SO
36
XVD
43
XVD
SYNC
0.5
0.5
R5590
0
SYNC
XHD_OUT
(FOR ADJUSTMENT)
2.8
C5519
1u
B 2012
COM_DC
VCO
OP_OUT
OP_IN-
OP_IN+
CPC
TG14
6.8
2.4
XHD
R5579
150k
1.4
0.5
2.8
MAKER_CHECK
13.4
19
COM_IN
VR
GND
VR
1.7
18
Vcc3
COM_OUT
C5518
1u B 2012
7.1
PSIG
GND
13
G_IN
RB5501
100X4
1.7
14
B_IN
R5577
470k
VG
10P
17
VREF
VG
13.4
C5517
1u B 2012
7.1
16
GND1
XP.SAVE
VB
XVD_OUT
10
Q5505
NDS356AP
LCD B+ REG
1.7
15
LPF_ADJ
7.1
24
VP
XVP.SAVE
FRP
PFRP
PRG
BLACK_IN
BGP
N.C.
GND2/N.C.
1.4
PANEL_R
R_DC_DET
IC5501
CXA3289AR-T4
BIAS
0.01u
1.8
48
1 TO(1/2)
VR
TRAP_ADJ
1.4
C5507
1.8
Vcc1
GND/N.C.
0.01u
0.01u
47
C5505
C5506
PANEL_G
DRIVER
1.4
PANEL_B
IC5501
XCS
SH_A
46
1.8
G_DC_DET
SH_B
2.8
45
R5503 100k
XP.SAVE
44
1.4
VG
SI
0.5
2.8
XSCK
2.8
R5501
470k
43
C5503
XX
B_DC_DET
SH_G
PANEL_2.8V
C5501
4.7u
B
EXT_DA
N.C./R_INJECT
37
42
2.8
XC.SAVE
SH_R
XCS_PANEL
L5501
47uH
2.7
R5522
22k
1
VB
0.5
2.0
XHD_OUT
N.C./C_BG
XSH.SAVE
XTG_SO
39
2.5
40
XVC_SCK
38
2.8
XC.SAVE
1.2
41
VB
SYNC
C5527
XX
DAC
BL_ON
R5551
47k
2 TO(1/2)
LED
DETIN
D5504
XX
M
16
4-21
4-22
LCD DRIVE, TG
PD-160 (2/2)
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
XX MARK:NO MOUNT
S023
CN002
REG_GND
XHI_RESET
SP+
BT001
(LITHIUM BATTERY)
D_2.8V
KEY_AD3
KEY_AD0
KEY_AD2
REG_GND
D_2.8V
XHI_RESET
C
TO
VC-276 BOARD(25/25)
CN1110
(PAGE 4-77
of LEVEL3)
R002
20k
R003
20k
14P
KEY_AD4
BATT_LI_3V
SP-
R004
20k
R027
20k
RESET
S007
SEL/PUSH EXEC
KEY_AD1
KEY_AD4
D_2.8V
10
REG_GND
KEY_AD3
11
DIAL_B
KEY_AD2
12
DIAL_A
OPEN/CLOSE SW
CH GND
LND002
D_2.8V
13
KEY_AD2
KEY_AD1
14
REG_GND
S004
FOCUS
R006 2400
R010 3000
S027
S010
S016
BACK LIGHT
R013
4400
FADER
R016 7800
EXPOSURE
CH GND
R019 16.4k
R022
54k
LND003
DIAL_B
DIAL_A
KEY_AD2
S001
(OPEN/CLOSE)
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
LCD_COM/XDATA
OSD_SO
XOSD_SCK
S026
S005
EVER_3.0V
MEMORY INDEX
DISP_BL
R007 2400
MPEG
S013
S028
S029
R011 3000
MEMORY MIX
R012 3000
TITLE
R014 4400
MEMORY DELETE
R015 4400
MENU
R017 7800
MEMORY(+)
S017
R020 16.4k
MEMORY(-)
R021 16.4k
VOLUME -
S018
R023 54k
MEMORY PLAY
R024 54k
DISPLAY
REG_GND
E
(DCR-TRV340)
CN005
TO
PD-160 BOARD(1/2)
CN5704
THROUGH THE
CP-076 HARNESS
6P
CL001
XCS_LCD_DRIVER
LCD_COM/XDATA
OSD_SO
XOSD_SCK
DISP_LCD_VDD
DISP_BL
(PAGE 4-19)
S003
CL002
S006
END SEARCH
CL003
R008 2400
PB ZOOM
1
SEIDEN_GND
5P
REG_GND
LND004
5
1
SP(-)
D2.8V
SP(+)
PAUSE
2P
KEY_AD0
CN004
VOLUME +
CL006
S024
SP901
SPEAKER
7800
CL005
EDITSEARCH(+)
2400
S025
R026 3000
EDITSEARCH(-)
CN006
CH GND
R409
10k
CL001
S405
PAUSE
SIGNAL PATH
AUDIO
SIGNAL
S401
SUPER NS/COLOUR SLOWS
REC
PB
S404
R403
1200
REW
R405
1500
S403
S409
S407
STOP
PLAY
R407
2200
S406
FF
R408
3900
S408
REC
R406
8200
16
4-23
S022
S015
R018
CL004
R025
S012
S009
4-24
S019
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
LS-057 (S/T REEL SENSOR), FP-228 (DEW SENSOR), FP-299 (MODE SWITCH), FP-300 (TAPE TOP), FP-302 (TAPE END), FP-301 (TAPE LED) FLEXIBLE BOARDS
FP-302
FLEXIBLE
LS-057 BOARD
FP-300
FLEXIBLE
Q002
TAPE END
SENSOR
Q001
TAPE TOP
SENSOR
FP-301
FLEXIBLE
D001
TAPE LED
Q001
TAPE TOP
SENSOR
1-680-436-
H002
3
S REEL
SENSOR
4
1
2
15
ME/MP
H001
3
2
T REEL
SENSOR
4
1
LS-057 BOARD
(CONDUCTOR SIDE)
15
S001
REC PROOF
FP-299
FLEXIBLE
15
Hi8 MP
S002
C.C. LOCK
S001
o'
FP-299
FLEXIBLE
DEW SENSOR
1-680-437-
MR SENSOR
S_REEL (+)
SENSOR_VCC
T REEL (+)
10
T REEL (-)
12 ME/MP
13 REC_PROOF
14 Hi8_MP
15 C_LOCK_SW
DEW
M-SW (A)
MR
2
SENSOR
3
FG1
FG VCC
FG2
FP-228
FLEXIBLE
7
8
REG_GND
9 CAP_U
10 CAP_U
11 CAP_W
M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR
12 CAP_W
13 CAP_V
14 CAP_V
FP-301 FLEXIBLE
(CONDUCTOR SIDE)
3
4
2
HE
3
4
2
HE
1-677-049- 11
3
TO
MECHA
CONTROL
BLOCK
VC-276
BOARD
(15/25)
CN4404
(PAGE4-57
of LEVEL 3)
FP-302 FLEXIBLE
(CONDUCTOR SIDE)
15
VH+
16
HU 1
17
HU 2
18
HV 1
19
HV 2
20
HW 1
21
HW 2
22
VH-
TO
MECHA
CONTROL
BLOCK
VC-276
BOARD
(15/25)
CN4403
(PAGE4-57
of LEVEL3)
2
HE
o'
1-680-434-
S_REEL (-)
M-SW (B)
11
DEW SENSOR
11
1-680-473-
11
Q002
TAPE END
SENSOR
1-680-438-
M-SW (C)
S901
MODE
SWITCH
REG_GND
C
B
A
COM
TAPE_LED (A)
H002
S REEL
SENSOR
TAPE_LED (K)
S002
C.C. LOCK
D001
TAPE LED
H001
T REEL
SENSOR
FP-228
FLEXIBLE
TAPE_END (C)
S901
MODE SWITCH
M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR
TAPE_TOP (C)
11 HALL COM
REC PROOF
11
11
22
4-25
/ DEW SENSOR / MODE SWITCH / TAPE TOP / TAPE END / TAPE LED
FP-228
FP-299
FP-300
FP-302
FP-301
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
FLEXIBLE
FP-410
AV TERMINAL
CN203
SHASSIS GND
5P
4
3
D-
VCC
USB
ID
CN202
CN1104
4P
24
REG_GND
23
REG_GND
22
D+
21
VCC
20
REG_GND
19
REG_GND
18
NTPA
NTPA
17
TPB
TPA
16
NTPB
TPB
15
NTPB
14
REG_GND
13
AV_JACK_IN
J201
12
AUDIO_L_I/O
SOL001
11
REG_GND
CL001
AUDIO/VIDEO
24P
D-
TPA
DV
IN/OUT
24
D+
CN203
GND
(USB)
(USB)
LND201
VIDEO_I/O
AUDIO_R_I/O
S_GND
Y
S_Y_I/O
SW
TO
VC-276 BOARD(24/25)
CN1104
(PAGE 4-75
of LEVEL3)
AUDIO/VIDEO
10
V
R
J201
5
4
REG_GND
S_C_I/O
XS_JACK_IN
CL003
S_GND
S VIDEO
DV
IN/OUT
REG_GND
CL002
CN202
1-683-626-
FP-410 FLEXIBLE
Y
S VIDEO
C
LND101
21
SHASSIS GND
MEMORY
S001
CAMERA
POWER
XVTR_MODE_SW
REG_GND
XPHOTO_STBY_SW
XCAM_MODE_SW
XS/S_SW
REG_GND
KEY_AD5
XPHOTO_FREEZE
OFF
MEMORY
VTR
CAMERA
S002
TO
VC-276 BOARD(25/25)
CN1109
START/STOP
OFF(CHG)
(PAGE 4-77
of LEVEL3)
VTR
(DCR-TRV340)
3
1
2
4
4
S003
S004
(PHOTO FREEZE)
PHOTO
REG_GND
D_2.8V
10
ZOOM_VR
11
XEJECT_SW
12
OPEN/EJECT
R001
1k
SIGNAL PATH
VIDEO SIGNAL
LND001
SEIDEN GND
SS-1380
CHROMA
Y/CHROMA
AUDIO
SIGNAL
REC
PB
Schematic diagram and printed wiring board of the VC-276 board are not shown.
Pages from 4-29 to 4-82 are not shown.
16
RV001
20k
ZOOM
W
T
/ FP-410 FLEXIBLE
4-28
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4-3. WAVEFORMS
CD-357 BOARD
CAMERA REC
1 IC551 1
7 IC551 qd,qf
8.3Vp-p
3.2Vp-p
H
74 nsec
2 IC551 2
8 CN551 3
24.0Vp-p
1.4Vp-p
v
H
3 IC551 3
8.3Vp-p
4 IC551 4
23.6Vp-p
5 IC551 7
1.4Vp-p
6 IC551 9,qs
3.1Vp-p
74 nsec
4-83
WAVEFORMS
CD-357
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
PD-160 BOARD
1 IC5501 wf LCD
7 IC5502 1 LCD
2.8Vp-p
8.2Vp-p
2H
2 IC5501 ws LCD
8 IC5502 wh LCD
2.8Vp-p
7.9Vp-p
2H
170 nsec
9 IC5502 rk LCD
3 IC5501 w; LCD
2.8Vp-p
7.9Vp-p
2H
0 IC5701 2
4 IC5501 rk LCD
540mVp-p
2.9Vp-p
H
40 sec
5 IC5501 rj LCD
540mVp-p
6 IC5501 rh LCD
540mVp-p
WAVEFORMS
PD-160
4-84
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
no mark : side A
* mark : side B
C552
C554
C556
C557
C560
C561
C562
A-4
B-4
A-4
B-4
A-4
B-4
B-4
SI-032 BOARD
C305
C309
C310
C311
C312
* C313
* C314
* C315
B-1
B-1
C-2
C-2
C-1
A-5
A-5
A-5
* CN551 B-3
* D551
B-4
* FB552
A-3
IC551
A-1
* L552
A-4
* Q551
B-4
R551
R553
R557
R558
R563
R564
R565
R566
R567
R568
R569
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
A-3
A-3
A-3
A-3
A-3
B-4
A-3
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
* CN301 B-5
* CN302 B-5
* CN304 A-6
D301
D302
D303
D304
D306
D309
D310
D311
D312
D313
A-2
A-2
B-5
B-5
B-2
B-5
B-5
B-2
B-2
B-5
FB301
FB302
C-2
B-1
IC301
A-1
Q301
B-2
R301
R307
* R316
R319
R320
R321
B-2
B-2
B-5
A-1
A-1
B-2
* SE301
* SE302
C-5
C-6
*
*
*
*
* VDR301 B-5
* VDR302 B-5
* VDR303 B-5
PD-160 BOARD
C5501
C5503
C5504
C5505
C5506
C5507
C5508
C5509
C5510
C5511
C5512
C5515
C5516
C5517
C5518
C5519
C5527
C5529
C5532
C5533
C5534
C5536
C5538
C5540
C5602
C5604
C5605
C5606
C5607
C5608
C5701
B-3
B-3
B-5
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-2
B-3
B-4
B-4
B-4
C-4
C-3
C-3
C-4
B-3
B-4
B-3
D-5
D-5
C-5
C-5
D-6
D-4
D-3
B-6
B-6
D-2
D-4
A-3
CN5501
CN5502
CN5601
CN5701
CN5702
CN5703
CN5704
CN5705
D-5
C-3
D-2
B-1
A-1
A-5
A-2
A-6
D5502
D5503
D5504
D5601
* D5602
D5603
D5604
* D5605
C-4
D-5
B-5
C-6
D-11
B-1
B-2
D-11
FB5502 B-4
FB5504 C-1
Q5501
Q5503
Q5504
Q5505
Q5506
Q5508
Q5601
Q5602
Q5603
B-4
C-5
D-5
C-5
B-5
C-5
B-5
D-3
B-6
R5501
R5503
R5504
R5505
R5506
R5507
R5508
R5509
R5510
R5511
R5512
R5522
R5551
R5560
R5572
R5573
R5574
R5575
R5576
R5577
R5579
R5588
R5590
R5591
R5609
R5610
R5611
R5612
R5613
R5614
R5616
R5617
R5618
R5619
R5620
R5621
R5702
R5704
B-3
B-4
B-4
B-3
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
B-4
C-3
B-6
B-4
C-5
C-5
C-5
C-5
C-5
B-5
C-6
D-5
B-4
B-4
B-6
D-3
B-6
B-6
D-4
B-6
B-6
B-6
C-6
B-2
B-2
B-6
B-1
A-3
RB5501 C-3
RB5502 C-4
T5601
PARTS LOCATION
CD-357, SI-032, PD-160
IC5501
IC5502
IC5601
IC5602
IC5701
B-3
B-5
B-6
B-6
A-3
L5501
L5504
L5505
L5601
L5602
B-3
C-2
B-4
D-4
D-4
4-90E
D-3
SECTION 5
ADJUSTMENTS
5-1
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1.
When replacing main parts, adjust the items indicated by z in the following table.
Replaced parts
Parts replacement
Adjustment
Section
Adjustment
Lens device
LCD block
ND901 (Fluorescent tube)
LCD block
LCD901 (LCD panel)
Mechanism deck *1
Mechanism deck M901 (Drum assy.) *1
Mechanism deck M902 (Capstan motor)
Mechanism deck LS chassis assy
CD-357 board IC551 (CCD imager)
PD-160 board IC5501 (RGB driver (LCD))
PD-160 board IC5502 (Timing generator (LCD))
PD-160 board Q5602/5604, T5601 (Inverter)
SI-032 board SE301,302 (PITCH,YAW sensor)
VC-276 board IC1501, X1501 (Timing generator)
VC-276 board IC1502 (S/H, AGC)
VC-276 board IC2201 (Hi8/Std8 Y/C process)
VC-276 board IC3103 (REC/PB AMP)
VC-276 board IC3101 (EQ, A/D conv. PLL)
VC-276 board IC3701 VIDEO IN/OUT)
VC-276 board IC3301 (DV signal process)
VC-276 board IC2291 (EVR)
VC-276 board IC5701 (AUDIO IN/OUT, AFM)
VC-276 board IC7001 (LCD driver (EVF))
VC-276 board IC7002 (Timing generator (EVF))
Block replacement
5-2
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z z
z
z
z
z z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z z
z z
z z
z
z
z
z z
z z
z
z
z
z z
z z
z z
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
5-3
Supporting RadarW
IC4903 (EEPROM) *2 *4
VC-276 board
IC4802 (EEPROM) *3
IC4502 (EEPROM)
VC-276 board
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
VC-276 board
(COMPLETE)
EEPROM
replacement
VC-276 board
(COMPLETE)
PD-160 board
Adjustment
(COMPLETE)
Adjustment
Section
SI-032 board
Board
replacement
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
z
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Vectorscope
Name
Parts Code
Usage
J-6080-058-A
ND filter 1.0
J-6080-808-A
J-2
ND filter 0.4
ND filter 0.1
J-6080-806-A
J-6080-807-A
J-3
J-4
J-6082-200-A
J-6020-250-A
J-1
J-6
J-6080-875-A
J-7
J-8
J-6080-621-A
J-6082-311-A
J-9
CPC-13 jig
J-6082-443-A
J-10
Minipattern box
J-6082-353-B
J-11
Camera base
J-6082-384-A
J-5
J-6082-053-B
J-1
J-2
J-3
J-4
J-5
J-6
J-7
J-8
J-9
J-10
J-11
Fig. 5-1-1.
5-4
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-1-2.
Preparations
Note1: For details of how remove the cabinet and boards, refer to 2.
DISASSEMBLY.
Note2: When performing only the adjustments, the lens block and boards
need not be disassembled.
Note3: Before performing the adjustments, check the data of page: 0,
address: 10 is 00. If not, set data: 00 to this address.
1)
2)
Pattern box
1.5 m
Fig. 5-1-2.
5-5
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Terminated at 75
Adjustment remote
commander
Vector scope
Color monitor
VIDEO
(Yellow)
AUDIO L
(White)
AUDIO R
(Red)
EVF block
Memory stick
slot
DCR-TRV340
Front
panel
block
CN4404
Lens block
CN4403
CN4402
CN3101
CN
4401
CN1501
CN7001
CN1551
LANC
jack
CN1103
DC IN
jack
CN1105
CN1107
VC-276
board
CN4001
CN1108
CN1109
Must be connected.
CN1106
AC power adaptor
(8.4Vdc)
AC-L10,
AC-VQ800 etc.
CN1110
SI-032 board
CN301
Must be
connected.
AUDIO/VIDEO
jack
Must be connected.
To CF-2500 block
CN5601
Must be connected
when performing the
LCD system adjustments.
CN5501
CN5701
CN5502
CN5702
CN5704
To PD-160 board
CN5701
CPC-13 jig
(J-6082-443-A)
CN5703
CN5705
PD-160 board
Fig. 5-1-3.
5-6
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-1-3. Precaution
1. Setting the Switch
Unless otherwise specified, set the switches as follows and perform
adjustments without loading cassette.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
2. Order of Adjustments
Basically carry out adjustments in the order given.
C=D
Yellow
Cyan
Green
White
Magenta
Red
Blue
Blue
Yellow
Cyan
Green
White
Magenta
Red
V
A B
A=B
B A
Enlargement
Fig. a
(VIDEO terminal
output waveform)
Difference in level
Fig.5-1-4.
3. Subjects
1) Color bar chart (Color reproduction adjustment frame)
When performing adjustments using the color bar chart, adjust
the picture frame as shown in Fig. 5-1-4. (Color reproduction
adjustment frame)
2) Clear chart (Color reproduction adjustment frame)
Remove the color bar chart from the pattern box and insert a
clear chart in its place. (Do not perform zoom operations during
this time.)
3) Flange back adjustment chart
Make the chart shown in Fig. 5-1-5 using A0 size (1189mm
841mm) black and white vellum paper.
White
841mm
Black
1189mm
Fig. 5-1-5.
Note: Use matte vellum paper bigger than A0, and make sure the edges of
the black and white paper joined together are not rough.
5-7
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2.
Note1: When reading or writing the 1B, 1C, 1D page data, select page: 0,
address: 10, and set data: 01, then select B, C or D page. The 1B.
1C or 1D page can be chosen by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: The A, B and 1B page are DCR-TRV340 model only.
[Initialization Procedure]
DCR-TRV240 :
1. Initialization of D page data
2. Initialization of 8, C, 1C page data
3. Initialization of E, F, 1F page data
DCR-TRV340 :
1. Initialization of A, D page data
2. Initialization of B, 1B page data
3. Initialization of 8, C, 1C page data
4. Initialization of E, F, 1F page data
Digital voltmeter
Battery terminal
Fig. 5-1-6.
5-8
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2-1.
3. D Page Table
Adjusting page
Adjusting Address
10 to FF
Initializing Method:
Order Page Address Data
0
0
01
10
01
00
3
4
2
2
00
01
2D
2D
02
00
29
01
29
00 to 0F
10
11
12
13 to 32
33
34 to 42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
4A to 4C
4D
4E to 4F
50
51
52
53
54
55 to 57
58
59
5A
5B
5C
5D to 64
65
66
67
68
69 to 6B
6C
6D
6E
6F
70 to 77
78
79
7A
7B
7C
7D to 8D
8E
8F
90 to B6
B7
B8 to CF
D0
D1
D2 to FF
Procedure
1
2
Address
3)
2
2
00
01
29
29
Initial value
00
Remark
Test mode
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in
the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in
the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in
the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in
the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
00
00
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Drum rotation counted time.
(Refer to 4-3. SERVICE MODE.)
Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-2.
5-9
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2-2.
Adjusting page
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
10 to 67
A
Adjusting Address
10 to FF
Initializing Method:
Order Page Address Data
10
00
00
29
01
29
Procedure
0
0
01
10
01
00
3
4
7
7
03
00
00
28
01
28
02
7
8
2
2
00
01
29
29
Address
00 to 0F
10
11 to 15
16
17 to 21
22
23
24
25
26
27 to 29
2A
2B
2C to 36
37
38 to 39
3A
3B to 49
4A
4B
4C
4D
4E
4F to 67
3)
0
2
3. D Page Table
1
2
1
2
Remark
Initial value
00
Test mode
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built
in the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built
in the same model.)
Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-3.
4. A Page Table
Note1: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the A, D
Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of A, D
Page Data.)
Address
Remark
00 to 0F
10 to 17 Fixed data-1
18
Fixed data-2
19 to FF Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-4.
5-10
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2-3.
Note: When reading or writing the B page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 00.
When reading or writing the 1B page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select B page. The 1B page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
1
2
0
2
10
00
00
29
01
29
Setting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
0
0
01
10
01
00
0E
00
Adjusting page
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
00 to FF
1B
03
20
Adjusting Address
00 to FF
01
FA
00
01
Initializing Method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
2
0
0
01
10
01
00
7
8
5
2
0E
00
29
3
4
5
5
02
01
FF
F3
01
29
00
01
02
00
29
01
29
4. B Page Table
Note1: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the B, 1B
Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of B, 1B
Page Data.)
Address
Remark
00 to 8C Fixed data-1
8D
Fixed data-2
8E to FF Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-5.
5. 1B Page Table
Note1: When reading or writing the 1B page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select B page. The 1B page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the B, 1B
Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of B, 1B
Page Data.)
Modifying Method:
1) Before changing the data, select page: 0, address: 01, and set
data: 01.
2) When changing the B page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 00.
3) When changing the 1B page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 01.
After completing the modification of 1B page data, reset the
data of this address to 00.
4) New data for changing are not shown in the tables because
they are different in destination. When changing the data, copy
the data built in the same model.
Address
Remark
00 to FF Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-6.
Note: If copy the data built in the different model, the camcorder may
not operate.
5)
Procedure
5-11
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2-4.
Note: When reading or writing the 8, C page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 00.
When reading or writing the 1C page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select C page. The 1C page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Modifying Method:
1) Before changing the data, select page: 0, address: 01, and set
data: 01.
2) When changing the 8, C page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 00.
3) When changing the 1C page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 01.
After completing the modification of 1C page data, reset the
data of this address to 00.
4) New data for changing are not shown in the tables because
they are different in destination. When changing the data, copy
the data built in the same model.
Adjusting page
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
00 to A3
C
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
10 to FF
1C
Adjusting Address
00 to FF
Note: If copy the data built in the different model, the camcorder may
not operate.
5)
6)
Initializing Method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
2
3
0
3
10
81
00
10
80
0C
80
6
7
8
2
2
00
01
29
29
1
2
0
2
10
00
00
29
01
29
3. C Page Table
Note1: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the 8, C,
1C Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of 8, C,
1C Page Data.)
Address
00 to 0F
10
11
12
13
14 to 15
16
17
18
19
1A
1B
1C
1D
1E
1F
20
21
22
23 to 24
25
Perform Modification of 8, C, 1C
Page Data.
5-12
Initial value
EE
00
00
00
E0
E0
20
20
25
25
25
3E
3E
CA
99
88
Remark
Switching position adj.
Fixed data-1
Hi8/std8 CAP FG duty adj.
Reel FG adj.
AEQ adj.
Fixed data-1
AEQ adj.
Fixed data-1
AGC center level adj.
PLL fo adj.
APC adj.
LPF fo adj.
Fixed data-1
S VIDEO out Y level adj.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
C page
Address
Remark
Initial value
26
E3
S VIDEO out Cr level adj.
27
A1
S VIDEO out Cb level adj.
28
Fixed data-2
29
20
PLL fo adj.
2A to 2B
Fixed data-1
2C
03
APC adj.
2D
Fixed data-1
2E
Fixed data-2
2F
E0
Reel FG adj.
30 to 3F
Fixed data-1
40
0A
Hi8/std8 switching position adj.
41
00
42
Fixed data-1
43
50
Hi8/std8 AFC fo adj.
44
69
Hi8/Std8 Y/C output level set
45
64
46 to 4B
Fixed data-1
4C
A6
Hi8/std8 AFM 1.5MHz deviation adj.
4D
94
Hi8/std8 AFM 1.7MHz deviation adj.
4E
80
Hi8/std8 AFM BPF fo adj.
4F
Fixed data-2
50
51
61
VCO adj. (EVF)
52
76
53
Fixed data-1
54
9D
RGB AMP adj. (EVF)
55 to 57
Fixed data-1
58
2B
Contrast adj. (EVF)
59
Fixed data-1
5A
Fixed data-2
5B to 5E
Fixed data-1
5F
Fixed data-2
60
61
5C
VCO adj. (LCD)
62
70
63
21
V-COM adj. (LCD)
64
9D
RGB AMP adj. (LCD)
65
08
Black limit adj. (LCD)
66
3D
PSIG gray adj. (LCD)
67
7E
White balance adj. (LCD)
68
6C
69
20
Contrast adj. (LCD)
6A
37
Center level adj. (LCD)
6B
Fixed data-2
6C
6D
Fixed data-1
6E
Fixed data-2
6F to 81
Fixed data-1
82
Fixed data-2
83 to 85
Fixed data-1
86
Fixed data-2
87 to 88
Fixed data-1
89
Fixed data-2
8A
8B to AE
Fixed data-1
Address
AF
B0 to E1
E2
E3
E4 to F3
F4
F5
F6
F7
F8
F9
FA
FB
FC
FD
FE
FF
Initial value
Remark
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
Fixed data-1
Emergency memory address
Table. 5-1-7.
5-13
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4. 8 Page Table
5. 1C Page Table
Note1: When reading or writing the 1C page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select C page. The 1C page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the 8, C,
1C Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of 8, C,
1C Page Data.)
Address
00 to 18
19
20 to 34
35
36 to 49
4A
4B to 79
7A
7B
7C
7D
7E
7F
80
81
82
83
84 to 89
8A
8B
8C
8D
8E
8F
90
91
92
93
94 to A3
Initial value
Remark
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in
the same model.)
08
00
46
01
02
00
00
00
Address
Remark
00 to 49 Fixed data-1
4A
Fixed data-2
4B to FF Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-9.
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Serial No. input
Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-8.
5-14
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-2-5.
Note: When reading or writing the E, F page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 00.
When reading or writing the 1F page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select F page. The 1F page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Modifying Method:
1) Before changing the data, select page: 0, address: 01, and set
data: 01.
2) When changing the E, F page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 00.
3) When changing the 1F page data, select page: 0, address: 10,
and set data: 01.
After completing the modification of 1F page data, reset the
data of this address to 00.
4) New data for changing are not shown in the tables because
they are different in destination. When changing the data, copy
the data built in the same model.
Adjusting page
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
00 to FF
F
Adjusting Address
Adjusting page
10 to FF
1F
Adjusting Address
00 to D9
Initializing Method:
Order Page Address Data
Note: If copy the data built in the different model, the camcorder may
not operate.
5)
6)
Procedure
1
2
0
2
10
00
00
29
01
29
1
2
3
0
0
6
01
10
01
01
00
2D
03
01
02
6
7
2
2
00
01
29
29
Address
3. F Page Table
00 to 0F
10 to 11
12
13 to 16
17
18
19
1A to 1D
1E
1F
20 to 29
2A
2B
2C
2D
2E
2F
30 to 32
33
34
35
36 to 39
Perform Modification of E, F, 1F
Page Data.
5-15
Initial value
80
81
5D
8A
80
7A
4D
3E
64
59
96
7A
22
27
Remark
Fixed data-1
27MHz origin osc. Adj.
Fixed data-1
HALL adj.
Fixed data-1
AWB & LV standard data input
Fixed data-1
AWB & LV standard data input
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
F page
4. E Page Table
Address
Remark
Initial value
3A
00
Color reproduction adj.
3B
F1
3C to 45
Fixed data-1
46
2A
Flange back adj.
47
18
48
37
49
0D
4A
13
4B
08
4C
00
4D
00
4E
00
4F
00
50
6E
51
19
52
00
53
19
54
04
55
00
56
00
57 to 5B
Fixed data-1
5C
Fixed data-2
5D
5E
00
Optical axis adj.
5F to 8D
Fixed data-1
8E
Fixed data-2
8F to 93
Fixed data-1
94
Fixed data-2
95 to 99
Fixed data-1
9A
Fixed data-2
9B to C7
Fixed data-1
C8
Fixed data-2
C9 to D6
Fixed data-1
D7
Fixed data-2
D8 to ED
Fixed data-1
EE
Fixed data-2
EF to F6
Fixed data-1
F7
Fixed data-2
F8 to FF
Fixed data-1
Address
00 to 05
06
07
08 to 35
36
37 to 9B
9C
9D
9E
9F
A0
A1
A2 to AA
AB
AC to BE
BF
C0
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5 to E9
EA
EB
EC to FF
Remark
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
(Modified data. Copy the data built in the same
model.)
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Table. 5-1-11.
5. 1F Page Table
Note1: When reading or writing the 1F page data, select page: 0, address:
10, and set data: 01, then select F page. The 1F page can be chosen
by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: Fixed data-1: Initialized data. (Refer to 1. Initializing the E, F, 1F
Page Data.)
Fixed data-2: Modified data. (Refer to 2. Modification of E, F,
1F Page Data.)
Table. 5-1-10.
Address
00 to 51
52
53 to 5A
5B
5C to 64
65
66
67 to D8
D9
Remark
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Fixed data-1
Fixed data-2
Table. 5-1-12.
5-16
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-3.
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
F
17, 18, 19
Specified Value 1
Specified Value 2
89 to 8D
15 to 19
Switch setting:
POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
2
6
94
8B Set the data.
6
6
95
01
02
01
17
6D
00
Checking method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
03
03 Set the data.
2
6
6
94
95
00
00
3
4
0
6
03
01
00
00
01
00
RadarW
For detecting the position of the lens iris, adjust AMP gain and
offset.
Subject
Not required
3
4
1
2
01
01
01
03
5-17
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Adjustment Address
46 to 56
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
01
01
01
13
01
27
02
3
4
Red (+)
Black ()
Yellow (SENS +)
White (SENS )
01
48
1
2
5)
0
6
Preparations:
1) The minipattern box is installed as shown in the following
figure.
3)
4)
1
2
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) SLOW SHUTTER/SUPER NIGHT SHOT ..................... OFF
2)
Procedure
Black (GND)
Fig. 5-1-7.
5-18
6
0
48
01
00
00
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Adjustment Address
46 to 56
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
F
46 to 56
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) SLOW SHUTTER/SUPER NIGHT SHOT ..................... OFF
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) SLOW SHUTTER/SUPER NIGHT SHOT ..................... OFF
Preparations:
1) Set the zoom lens to the TELE end and expose a subject that is
more than 500m away (subject with clear contrast such as
building, etc.). (Nearby subjects less than 500m away should
not be in the screen.)
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Adjusting method:
Procedure
1
2
3
0
6
6
01
48
01
01
01
13
01
15
02
48
01
01
13
01
29
02
6
6
2
3
4
5-19
01
00
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Specified Value
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) SLOW SHUTTER/SUPER NIGHT SHOT ..................... OFF
Note: When the auto focus is ON, the lens can be checked if it is focused
or not by observing the data on the page 1 of the adjustment remote
commander.
1) Select page: 0, address: 03, and set data: 0F.
2) Page 1 shows the state of the focus.
1 : 00 : XX
Odd: Focused
Even: Unfocused
Checking method:
1) Select page: 6, address: 40, and set data: 01.
2) Select page: 6, address: 41, and set data: 01.
3) Place the Siemens star 2.0m from the front of the lens.
4) To open the IRIS, decrease the luminous intensity to the
Siemens star up to a point before noise appear on the image.
5) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom TELE end.
6) Turn on the auto focus.
7) Check that the lens is focused (Note).
8) Select page: 6, address: 21, and set data: 10.
9) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom WIDE end.
10) Observe the TV monitor and check that the lens is focused.
Processing after Completing Adjustments:
1) Select page: 6, address: 21, and set data: 00.
2) Select page: 6, address: 40, and set data: 00.
3) Select page: 6, address: 41, and set data: 00.
4) Select page: 0, address: 03, and set data: 00.
5-20
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
F
5E
Area
Display phase
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
22.6 to 67.5
67.6 to 112.5
112.6 to 157.5
157.6 to 202.5
202.6 to 247.5
247.6 to 292.5
292.6 to 337.5
337.6 to 22.5
Correction data
Page: F, Address: 5E
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
Table 5-1-13.
Processing after Completing Adjustments:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
3) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Preparations before adjustments:
1) Playback the monoscope segment of the system check tape
(WR5-5ND).
2) Attach the optical axis frame chart (transparent) on the monitor
TV screen. Center of monoscope image and that that of optical
axis frame must be agree.
3) Set to the camera mode.
Adjusting method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Select page: F, address: 5E, set data: 00, and press the PAUSE
button.
3) Place the Siemens star 2.0 m away from the front of the lens.
4) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom TELE end.
5) Point the lens toward the Siemens star chart until center of the
Siemens star is located in the center of the optical axis frame.
6) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom WIDE end.
7) Measure on the monitor TV screen in which area of the optical
axis frame the center of the Siemens star is located. Measure
the amount of displacement (distance between the center of
the Siemens star and the center of the optical axis frame.) The
measurement value is named L1.
8) Read the correction data corresponding to the area from Table
5-1-13.
9) Input the correction data to page: F, address: 5E, and press the
PAUSE button
10) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom TELE end.
11) Point the lens toward the Siemens star chart until center of the
Siemens star is located in the center of the optical axis frame.
12) Shoot the Siemens star with the zoom WIDE end.
13) Measure the amount of displacement (distance between the
center of the Siemens star and the center of the optical axis
frame.) The measurement value is named L2.
14) Compare the values L1 and L2, and confirm that L2 is smaller
than L1. If L2 is lager than L1, select page: F, address: 5E, set
data: 00, and press the PAUSE button.
Fig. 5-1-8.
5-21
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Specified Value
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
4) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Setting method:
1) Select page: 6, address: 48, and set data: 01.
2) Adjust the zoom and the camera direction, and set to the
specified position.
3) Mark the position of the picture frame on the monitor display,
and adjust the picture frame to this position in following
adjustments using Color reproduction adjustment frame.
1. Horizontal period
A=B
C=D
Fig. 5-1-9.
2. Vertical period
E=F
Fig. 5-1-10.
Check on the monitor TV (Underscanned mode)
Fig. 5-1-11.
5-22
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
F
33, 35, 3A, 3B
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
F
1E, 1F, 2A to 2D
Specified Value
Specified Value
0FF0 to 1010
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
4) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Adjusting method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Select page: 6, address: 48, and set data: 01.
3) Select page: 6, address: 9D, set data: 30.
4) Select page: 6, address: 01, set data: 3D, and press the PAUSE
button.
5) Select page: F, address: D0, set data: 37, and press the PAUSE
button.
6) Adjust the GAIN and PHASE of the vectorscope, and adjust
the burst luminance point to the burst position of the color
reproduction frame.
7) Change the data of page: F, address: 33, 35, 3A, 3B, settle each
color luminance point in each color reproduction frame.
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
4) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
3
0
6
6
01
48
16
Procedure
01
01
02
4
5
01
11
01
0D
02
8
9
0
1
03
1E
Burst position
2
3
6
6
16
48
00
00
4
5
0
0
01
03
00
00
Fig. 5-1-12.
5-23
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2E, 2F
R ratio: 2BC0 to 2CC0
B ratio: 5920 to 5A20
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
4) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Procedure
Place the C14 filter for color
temperature correction on the lens.
Set the data.
01
01
3
4
6
F
48
3E
01
3E
2C
3F
3F
40
40
40
59
10
41
11
41
A0
12
01
83
13
01
81
14
02
15
01
3F
16
03
04
17
18
19
0
1
05
5-24
2
3
6
F
48
3E
00
3F
40
41
03
00
01
00
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Vectorscope
Fig. 5-1-13. A to B
Switch setting:
1) POWER .................................................................. CAMERA
2) NIGHT SHOT .................................................................. OFF
3) DIGITAL ZOOM (Menu display) ................................... OFF
4) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ..................................... OFF
Checking method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
48
01
01
0F
01
00
01
3F
B-Y
2mm
10
11
01
00
12
13
0
1
03
06
B-Y
3mm
3mm
2mm
6
7
R-Y
Procedure
Indoor white balance check
6
0
48
03
00
00
5-25
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Arbitrary
Display data of page 1 (Note1)
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Switch setting:
1) STEADY SHOT (Menu display) ...................................... ON
2) ZOOM .................................................................... TELE end
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
0
1
03
03
11
12
Procedure
Pitch sensor check
(SI-032 board SE301)
Set the data.
Check that the display data
(Note1) satisfies the specified
value.
Yaw sensor check
(SI-032 board SE302)
Set the data.
Check that the display data
(Note1) satisfies the specified
value.
03
00
5-26
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-4.
[Adjusting connector]
Most of the measuring points for adjusting the viewfinder system
are concentrated in CN1108 of VC-276 board.
Connect the Measuring Instruments via the CPC-13 jig (J-6082443-A).
The following table shows the Pin No. and signal name of CN1108.
Pin No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Signal Name
REG GND
N. C.
BPF MONI
N. C.
PB RF
REG GND
N. C.
RF SWP
N. C.
N. C.
Pin No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Subject
Measurement Point
Arbitrary
Pin qa of CN1108 (VCO)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Frequency counter
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
51, 52
f = 15734 30Hz
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
Signal Name
VCO
EVF VG
RF SWP
N. C.
CAP FG
RF MON
N. C.
REG GND
REG GND
REG GND
51
51
51
5
6
Table 5-1-14.
CN1108
1
20
52
D52
01
00
Remove the
CPC lid
Fig. 5-1-14.
5-27
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Arbitrary
Pin qs of CN1108 (EVF VG)
Subject
Measurement Point
Arbitrary
Pin qs of CN1108 (EVF VG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
54
A = 7.50 0.10V
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
58
A = 2.49 0.10V
Adjusting method:
Adjusting method:
54
54
01
00
58
58
01
Pedestal
100 IRE
2H
2H
Pedestal
Pedestal
Fig. 5-1-15.
Fig. 5-1-16.
5-28
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
1-5.
[Adjusting connector]
Most of the measuring points for adjusting the LCD system are
concentrated in CN5502 of the PD-160 board. Connect the
measuring instruments via the multi CPC jig (J-6082-311-A). The
following table shows the Pin No. and signal name of CN5502.
Pin No.
1
3
5
7
9
Signal Name
VB
VG
VR
XHD
GND
Pin No.
2
4
6
8
10
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Pin 8 of CN5502 (HSY)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Frequency counter
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
61, 62
f = 15734 30Hz
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
Signal Name
XVD OUT
PSIG
MAKER CHECK
XHD OUT
GND
61
61
61
Table 5-1-15.
5
PD-160 board
CN5502
9
1
10
2
62
D62
01
00
5-29
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
Pin 4 of CN5502 (PSIG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
66
A = 5.00 0.1V
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Pin 3 of CN5502 (VG)
Ext. trigger: Pin 4 of CN5502 (PSIG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
64
A = 7.68 0.05V
Adjusting method:
Note: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
66
66
01
Adjusting method:
64
64
01
00
Pedestal
A
2H
Fig. 5-1-17.
2H
Pedestal
Fig. 5-1-18.
5-30
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
Pin 4 of CN5502 (PSIG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
65
A = 8.30 0.08V
No signal
Pin 3 of CN5502 (VG)
Ext. trigger: Pin 4 of CN5502 (PSIG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
69
A = 2.72 0.05V
Adjusting method:
Adjusting method:
3
3
C4
C5
65
65
61
58
6
7
3
3
C4
C5
00
00
8
9
01
00
69
69
01
100 IRE
A
A
V
Fig. 5-1-19.
2H
Pedestal
Fig. 5-1-20.
5-31
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
Pin 3 of CN5502 (VG)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Digital voltmeter
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
6A
A = 7.00 0.03Vdc
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Check on LCD display
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
63
The brightness difference between the
section A and section B is minimum.
Adjusting method:
Note1: This adjustment should be carried out upon completion of the
following adjustments.
RGB AMP Adjustment
Black Limit Adjustment
Contrast Adjustment
Center Level Adjustment
Note2: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
6A
6A
01
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
2
63
3
4
C
C
63
63
01
Fig. 5-1-21.
5-32
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
Check on LCD screen
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
67, 68
The LCD screen should not be colored.
Note1: Check the white balance only when replacing the following parts.
If necessary, adjust them.
1. LCD panel
2. Light induction plate
3. IC5501
Note2: The data of page: 0, address: 10 must be 00.
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
2
67
7E
68
6C
68
67
67
68
68
68
10
01
00
5-33
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2-1-2.
2-1.
Hi8/STANDARD 8 MODE
Note3: Except for the camera recording mode and VTR recording
mode.
Pin No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Signal Name
VCO
EVF VG
RF SWP
N. C.
CAP FG
RF MON
N. C.
REG GND
REG GND
REG GND
Table 5-2-1.
[Procedure after operations]
1) Connect the adjustment remote commander, and turn on the
HOLD switch.
2) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
3) Select page: <2>[7], address: <4D>[62], and set data:
00.(Note2)
4) Select page: C, address: 3E, set data: 00, and press the PAUSE
button.
5) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
6) Remove the power supply from the unit.
Exit side
CH1
CH2
(Trigger)
V
Fig. 5-2-1.
5-34
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
2-2.
2-2-3.
DIGITAL8 MODE
2-2-1.
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
To quit the record mode, select page: 3, address: 01, set data:
00, and press the PAUSE button. (Whenever you want to quit
the record mode, be sure to quit following this procedure.)
2-2-2.
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
5)
To quit the playback mode, select page: 3, address: 01, set data:
00, and press the PAUSE button. (Whenever you want to quit
the playback mode, be sure to quit following this procedure.)
Must be flat
Pin qh
Pin qd
Fig. 5-2-2.
5-35
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Equipment to Required
1)
2)
TV monitor
Oscilloscope (dual-phenomenon, band width above 30 MHz
with delay mode) (Unless specified otherwise, use a 10 : 1
probe.)
3) Frequency counter
4) Pattern generator with video output terminal
5) Digital voltmeter
6) Audio generator
7) Audio level meter
8) Audio distortion meter
9) Audio attenuator
10) Regulated power supply
11) Digital8 alignment tapes
SW/OL standard (WR5-2D)
Parts code: 8-967-993-22
Audio operation check for NTSC (WR5-3ND)
Parts code: 8-967-993-32
System operation check for NTSC (WR5-5ND)
Parts code: 8-967-993-42
12) Hi8/standard8 alignment tapes
For tracking adjustment (WR5-1NP)
Parts code : 8-967-995-02
For video frequency characteristics adjustment (WR5-7NE)
Parts code : 8-967-995-13
For checking Standard 8 mode operations
For LP (WR5-4NL)
Parts code : 8-967-995-51
For SP (WR5-5NSP)
Parts code : 8-967-995-42
Note : The following alignment tapes can also be used.
WR5-4NSP (8-967-995-41)
5-36
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3-1-2.
Precautions on Adjusting
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
5-37
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Signal Name
REG GND
N. C.
BPF MONI
N. C.
PB RF
REG GND
N. C.
RF SWP
N. C.
N. C.
Pin No.
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
CN1108
1
Signal Name
VCO
EVF VG
RF SWP
N. C.
CAP FG
RF MON
N. C.
REG GND
REG GND
REG GND
20
Remove the
CPC lid
Table 5-3-1.
Fig. 5-3-1.
VIDEO
(Yellow)
Adjustment
remote
commander
AUDIO L
(White)
Main unit
AUDIO R
(Red)
LANC jack
AUDIO/VIDEO jack
Playback mode
TV monitor
VIDEO
(Yellow)
Main unit
AUDIO L (White)
Adjustment
remote
commander
AUDIO R (Red)
LANC jack
AUDIO/VIDEO jack
Fig. 5-3-2.
5-38
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Fig.5-3-3. shows the 75% color bar signals recorded on the alignment
tape.
Note: Measure using the VIDEO terminal (Terminated at 75).
White (100%)
Cyan
White (75%)
Green
Yellow
Video frequency
characteristics
WR5-7NE
Operation check
(SP mode)
WR5-5NSP
Operation check
(SP mode)
WR5-8NSE
Operation check
(LP mode)
WR5-4NL
Operation check
(LP mode)
WR5-8NLE
AFM stereo
Operation check
WR5-9NS
BPF adjustment
WR5-11NS
0.286V
Operation check
0.286V
Standard 8 MP
Hi8
ME
Standard 8 MP
Hi8
SP
SP
White
(100%)
Blue
Red
White
(75%)
Magenta
Tape path
adjustment
Switching
position
adjustment
Frequency
characteristics
adjustment
Green
Usage
Black
SP
ME
SP
Standard 8 MP
LP
Hi8
Cyan
0.714V
1V
Yellow
Magenta
Burst signal
Red
Blue
ME
LP
Standard 8 MP
SP
Standard 8 MP
SP
Checking
operations
AFM stereo
Checking
operations
BPF
adjustment
Tape type
ME ......... Particle type metal tape
MP .......... Evaporated type metal tape
5-39
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3-2.
Address
Note1: When reading or writing the 1B, 1C, 1D page data, select page: 0,
address: 10, and set data: 01, then select B, C or D page. The 1B.
1C or 1D page can be chosen by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: A page, B page and 1B page are DCR-TRV340 model only.
Input method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Read the serial No. on the name plate, and take it as D1.
Example: If the serial No. is 77881.
D1=77881
Note: Use six digits of the low rank when a serial No. is more than
seven digits.
3)
Input method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Input the following data to page: 8, addresses: 8C to 90.
Table 5-3-2.
3)
4)
91, 92, 93
Data
08
00
46
01
02
5-40
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
HexaHexaHexaHexaHexaHexaHexaHexaDecimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal Decimal decimal
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(D3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
(H3)
0
256
512
768
1024
1280
1536
1792
2048
2304
2560
2816
3072
3328
3584
3840
4096
4352
4608
4864
5120
5376
5632
5888
6144
6400
6656
6912
7168
7424
7680
7936
0000
0100
0200
0300
0400
0500
0600
0700
0800
0900
0A00
0B00
0C00
0D00
0E00
0F00
1000
1100
1200
1300
1400
1500
1600
1700
1800
1900
1A00
1B00
1C00
1D00
1E00
1F00
8192
8448
8704
8960
9216
9472
9728
9984
10240
10496
10752
11008
11264
11520
11776
12032
12288
12544
12800
13056
13312
13568
13824
14080
14336
14592
14848
15104
15360
15616
15872
16128
2000
2100
2200
2300
2400
2500
2600
2700
2800
2900
2A00
2B00
2C00
2D00
2E00
2F00
3000
3100
3200
3300
3400
3500
3600
3700
3800
3900
3A00
3B00
3C00
3D00
3E00
3F00
16384
16640
16896
17152
17408
17664
17920
18176
18432
18688
18944
19200
19456
19712
19968
20224
20480
20736
20992
21248
21504
21760
22016
22272
22528
22784
23040
23296
23552
23808
24064
24320
4000
4100
4200
4300
4400
4500
4600
4700
4800
4900
4A00
4B00
4C00
4D00
4E00
4F00
5000
5100
5200
5300
5400
5500
5600
5700
5800
5900
5A00
5B00
5C00
5D00
5E00
5F00
24576
24832
25088
25344
25600
25856
26112
26368
26624
26880
27136
27392
27648
27904
28160
28416
28672
28928
29184
29440
29696
29952
30208
30464
30720
30976
31232
31488
31744
32000
32256
32512
6000
6100
6200
6300
6400
6500
6600
6700
6800
6900
6A00
6B00
6C00
6D00
6E00
6F00
7000
7100
7200
7300
7400
7500
7600
7700
7800
7900
7A00
7B00
7C00
7D00
7E00
7F00
32768
33024
33280
33536
33792
34048
34304
34560
34816
35072
35328
35584
35840
36096
36352
36608
36864
37120
37376
37632
37888
38144
38400
38656
38912
39168
39424
39680
39936
40192
40448
40704
Table 5-3-3.
5-41
8000
8100
8200
8300
8400
8500
8600
8700
8800
8900
8A00
8B00
8C00
8D00
8E00
8F00
9000
9100
9200
9300
9400
9500
9600
9700
9800
9900
9A00
9B00
9C00
9D00
9E00
9F00
C000
C100
C200
C300
C400
C500
C600
C700
C800
C900
CA00
CB00
CC00
CD00
CE00
CF00
D000
D100
D200
D300
D400
D500
D600
D700
D800
D900
DA00
DB00
DC00
DD00
DE00
DF00
57344
57600
57856
58112
58368
58624
58880
59136
59392
59648
59904
60160
60416
60672
60928
61184
61440
61696
61952
62208
62464
62720
62976
63232
63488
63744
64000
64256
64512
64768
65024
65280
E000
E100
E200
E300
E400
E500
E600
E700
E800
E900
EA00
EB00
EC00
ED00
EE00
EF00
F000
F100
F200
F300
F400
F500
F600
F700
F800
F900
FA00
FB00
FC00
FD00
FE00
FF00
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3-3.
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
17, 2F
00 or 01 or 04 or 05
Mode
VTR stop
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
C
1F, 20, 22, 29
Specified Value
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
0
C
01
21
01
CA
01
00
01
30
02
03
01
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
Close the cassette compartment
without inserting a cassette.
2
0
01
01 Set the data.
3
01
02
03
01
1C
00
Procedure
1
2
RadarW
00
Note2: If it isnt satisfied, select page: C, address: 21, set the following
data, and press the PAUSE button, and repeat steps 3 to 6.
Setting data
When the data of page: C, address: 21 is CA. CE
When the data of page: C, address: 21 is CE.
When the data of page: C, address: 21 is C6.
C6
D2
C2
There are errors when it isnt satisfied even if the above treatment is
done.
If bit2, bit3, bit4, bit5 or bit 6 of the data of page: 3, address: 03 is
1, there are errors. For the error contents, see the following table.
(For the bit values, refer to 5-4. SERVICE MODE, 4-3. 3. Bit
value discrimination.)
Note: If the data is other value, adjustment has errors. (Take an appropriate
remedial measures according to the errors referring to the following
table.)
Data
02, 03, 06, 07
Contents of defect
T reel is defective
S reel is defective
S reel and T reel are defective
5-42
Error contents
bit 4 = 1 or bit 5 = 1
bit 6 = 1
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
Arbitrary
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
0
8
01
21
01
C8
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
Insert the SW/OL reference tape
and enter the VTR STOP mode.
2
3
0
C
01
10
21
01
02
03
10
01
01
EE
0D
00
RadarW
Mode
Signal
Playback
Recorded signal at Preparations before
adjustments
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
C
1E
Specified Value
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
Playback the recorded signal at
Preparations before adjustments
Note2: If the data of page: 3, address: 21 is 72, the tape top being played.
After playing the tape for 1 to 2 seconds, stop it, perform step 5
and higher.
Note3: If the data is other value, adjustment has errors. If bit 0 of the data
is 1, the A channel is defective. If bit 1 is 1, the B channel is
defective. Contents of the defect is written into page: C, addresses:
10 and 12. See the following table. (For the bit values, refer to 54. SERVICE MODE, 4-3. 3. Bit value discrimination. ) If bit 3
of the data is 1,the tape end being played, and adjustment has
errors.
Note4: If the data is EE, rewind the tape and repeat steps 1 to 7.
E7
2
3
0
<2>
[7]
4
5
33
08
01
23
02
03
01
01 Set the data.
<4D> <40> Set the data. (Note2)
[62] [01]
Procedure
Set the data.
Set the data.
5-43
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Playback
Signal
Measurement Point
RadarW
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
Procedure
1
2
0
<2>
[7]
01
01 Set the data.
<4D> <00> Set the data. (Note)
[62] [00]
3
4
3
8
33
21
00
00
01
00
PB RF signal is stable
Adjusting method:
Pin qh
18
20
19
20
1B
25
1C
25
21
CA
2C
03
8
9
10
<2>
[7]
3
Pin qd
13.3 msec
Fig. 5-3-4.
11
12
01
13
02
14
03
15
07
5-44
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
RadarW
Mode
Signal
VTR stop
Arbitrary
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Signal
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
C
1F, 20, 22, 29
Measurement Point
Specified Value
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
40, 41
t1 = 0 10 sec
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
0
3
01
01
02
03
01
01
30
Adjusting Method:
Procedure
00
Error contents
bit 2 = 1 or bit 3 = 1
bit 4 = 1 or bit 5 = 1
bit 6 = 1
0
C
<2>
[7]
2
3
01
3E
40
7
8
C
C
40
41
9
10
C
C
41
3E
11
<2>
[7]
0
12
01
40
CH2
Enlargement
CH1
t1=0 10 sec
CH2
Fig. 5-3-5.
5-45
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified value
16
Duty = 50 1 %
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
Set to the playback mode.
2
3
0
3
01
01
01
00
01
81
02
03
01
00
Note2: If the data of page: 3, address: 03 is other than 00, there are
errors. For the error contents, see the following table. (For the bit
values, refer to 5-4. SERVICE MODE, 4-3. 3. Bit value
discrimination.)
Error contents
bit 1 = 1
Adjustment time-out
Center of movement
A
B
Fig. 5-3-6.
5-46
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3-4.
Not required
Pin qh of IC1502
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Frequency counter
F
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
12
f = 13500000 68Hz
Mode
VTR stop
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Y signal terminal of S VIDEO jack
(75 terminated)
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
25
A = 1000 20mV
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
Adjusting method:
12
12
01
12
1
IC1502
0C
02
25
8
9
C
3
25
0C
10
<D>
[A]
<FE>
[12]
00
11
12
01
00
24 13
36
10
VC-276 board
25
<FE>
[12]
<D>
[A]
00
37 48
Fig. 5-3-7.
5-47
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
Chroma signal terminal of S VIDEO
jack (75 terminated)
External trigger: Y signal terminal of
S VIDEO jack
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
26, 27
Cr level: A = 714 14mV
Cb level: B = 714 14mV
Burst level: C = 286 6mV
Mode
VTR stop
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Video signal terminal of AUDIO/
VIDEO jack (75 terminated)
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Oscilloscope
Sync level: A = 293 18mV
Burst level: B = 286 18mV
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
Adjusting method:
<D>
[A]
<FE>
[12]
10
3
4
5
6
0C
02
26
26
27
10
27
11
0C
00
12
<D>
[A]
<FE>
[12]
00
13
14
01
00
<FE>
[12]
10
<D>
[A]
0C
02
0C
00
10
<D>
[A]
<FE>
[12]
00
11
12
01
00
B
A
H
Fig. 5-3-9.
0.28 sec
0.28 sec
Fig. 5-3-8.
5-48
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
No signal
C
Signal
Measurement Point
No signal
Display data of page: 3, address: 9D
Adjustment Address
44, 45
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
43
7C to 84
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
1
2
0
D
01
10
01
02
3
4
3
3
9E
A4
01
44
69
45
64
Procedure
Adjusting method:
Order Page Address Data
Procedure
1
0
01
01 Set the data.
7
8
44
A0
45
AA
10
11
3
D
9E
10
00
00
12
01
00
5-49
10
02
0D
04
4
5
3
3
93
9E
04
01
43
50
01
60
02
9
10
3
3
03
01
11
9D
12
0D
00
13
14
3
3
93
9E
00
00
15
10
00
16
01
00
00
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
3-5.
Signal
[Adjustment Procedure]
1) Hi8/Standard8 AFM BPF f0 adjustment
2) Hi8/Standard8 AFM 1.5MHz deviation adjustment
3) Hi8/Standard8 AFM 1.7MHz deviation adjustment
4) Digital8 playback level check
5) Overall level characteristics check
6) Overall distortion check
7) Overall noise level check
8) Overall separation check
Main unit
Audio oscillator
600
Playback
Main unit
TV monitor
Video (Yellow)
Left (White)
AUDIO/
VIDEO
47k
Right
(Red)
Distortion meter
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
4E
The Main and Sub channel distortion
rate should be almost the same (within
1%) and minimum.
Adjusting method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to 2.
3) Select page: C, address: 4E, change the data and minimize the
distortion rate.
4) Press the PAUSE button.
5) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to 1.
6) Select page: C, address: 4E, change the data and minimize the
distortion rate.
7) Press the PAUSE button.
8) Repeat steps 2) to 7) and set the data of address: 4E so that the
distortions rates when the Hi-Fi SOUND switch is set to 2
and set to 1 respectively are almost the same and minimum.
9) Press the PAUSE button.
10) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
11) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch to STEREO.
Right
Attenuator
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
MIC
Left
Measurement Point
47k
47k (1-249-437-11)
Fig. 5-3-10.
5-50
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
4C
7.5 2.0dBs
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Adjustment Page
Oscilloscope
C
Adjustment Address
Specified Value
4D
7.5 2.0dBs
Checking Method:
1) Check that the playback signal level is the specified value.
Adjusting method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to 1.
3) Select page: C, address: 4C, change the data and set the 400Hz
signal level to the specified value.
4) Press the PAUSE button.
5) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to STEREO.
6) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
Signal
Mode
Signal
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
7.5 3.0dBs
Checking Method:
1) Input the 400Hz, 66dBs signal in the MIC jack left and right.
2) Record the signal.
3) Playback the recorded section.
4) Check that the 400Hz signal level is the specified value.
Adjusting method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to 2.
3) Select page: C, address: 4D, change the data and set the 1kHz
signal level to the specified value.
4) Press the PAUSE button.
5) Set the Hi-Fi SOUND switch (menu display) to STEREO.
6) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
Mode
Signal
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Below 0.4%
(200Hz to 6kHz BPF ON)
Checking Method:
1) Input the 400Hz, 66dBs signal in the MIC jack left and right.
2) Record the signal.
3) Playback the recorded section.
4) Check that the distortion is the specified value.
5-51
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
Checking Method:
1) Connect the left terminal of MIC jack and its ground terminal
with a jumper wire.
2) Connect the right terminal of MIC jack and its ground terminal
with a jumper wire.
3) Record the signal.
4) Playback the recorded section.
5) Check that the noise level is the specified value.
6) Remove the jumper wires.
Measurement Point
Measuring Instrument
Specified Value
5-52
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Page
Data
Address
Fig. 5-4-1.
3)
Hexadecimal
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
notation
LCD Display
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A b c d E F
Decimal notation
conversion value 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011 12 1314 15
4)
Note1: When reading or writing the 1B, 1C, 1D page data, select page: 0,
address: 10, and set data: 01, then select B, C or D page. The 1B.
1C or 1D page can be chosen by this data setting.
After reading or writing, reset the data of page: 0, address: 10 to
00.
Note2: The A, B and 1B page are DCR-TRV340 model only.
5-53
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4-2.
DATA PROCESS
A
(A)
B
(b)
C
(c)
D
(d)
E
(E)
F
(F)
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
A (A)
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
B (b)
176
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
177
193
178
C (c)
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
D (d)
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
E (E)
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
F (F)
240
241
242
243
244
245
246
247
248
249
250
251
252
253
254
255
Upper digit
of hexadecimal
Note: The characters shown in the parenthesis ( ) shown the display on the adjustment remote commander.
(Example) If the DDS display or the adjustment remote commander shows BD (bd);
Because the upper digit of the adjustment number is B (b), and the lower digit is D (d), the meeting point
189 of 1 and 2 in the above table is the corresponding decimal number.
Table. 5-4-1.
5-54
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
4-3.
SERVICE MODE
Page C
Note1: After the completion of the all adjustments, cancel the service
mode by either of the following ways.
1) After data on page: C and D is restored, unplug the main power
supply and remove the coin lithium battery. ( In this case, date
and time and menu setting have been set by users are canceled.
Perform resetting.)
2) After data on page: C and D is restored, select page: 0, address:
01, and return the data to 00. And when data on page: 2, 3 and
7 are changed, return data to the original condition.
Note2: Before performing the adjustments, check the data of page: 0,
address: 10 is 00. If not, set data: 00 to this address.
Address
Contents
F4
EMG code when first error occurs
F6
F7
Page D
Data
00
01
02
Address F4 to FF
F8
FA
FB
Address 3E
Function
Normal
FC
Test mode
Various emergency prohibitions and releases
Drum emergency, capstan emergency, loading motor
emergency, reel emergency, tape top and end, DEW
detection
FE
FF
Address 10
Function
Normal
Forced camera power ON
Forced VTR power ON
Before setting the data , select page: 0, address: 01, and set data:
01.
For page C and D, the data set will be recorded in the non-volatile
memory by pressing the PAUSE button of the adjustment remote
commander. In this case, take note that the test mode will not be
exited even when the main power is turned off (8.4Vdc).
After completing adjustments/repairs, be sure to return the data
of page: C address: 3E to 00, and the data of page: D address: 10
to 00, and press the PAUSE button of the adjustment remote
commander. And select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
Initializing method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Select page: 3, address: 01, set data: 37, and press the PAUSE
button.
3) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
No error
Loading motor emergency during loading
11
22
23
24
5-55
30
40
42
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Unloading
Mechanism position
BL
LOAD
BL STOP BL
TURN
BL
REC/PB
BL
REW
0 1 0 1 = 5
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 0 0 0 = 0
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 1 0 0 = 4
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 1 1 0 = 6
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 0 1 0 = 2
MODE SW B
MODE SW A
USE
BL
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 0 1 1 = 3
MODE SW C
EJECT
0 1 1 1 = 7
0 0 0 1 = 1
MSB
Releasing lock of
cassette campartment
BL
USE
LOAD
STOP
TURN
REC/PB
REW
Contents
Position at which the cassette compartment lock is released. The mechanism will not move any
further in the unloading direction.
BLANC code. Between two codes. The mechanism will not be stopped by this code while it is
operating.
EJECT completion position. When the cassette is ejected, the mechanism will stop at this
position.
Code during loading/unloading. Code that is used while the LS chassis is moving.
Normal stop position. The pinch roller separates, the tension regulator returns, and the brakes of
both reels turn on.
Position at which is used when the pendulum gear swings from S to T or from T to S.
PB, REC, CUE, REV, PAUSE, FF positions.
The pinch roller is pressed and tension regulator is on.
REW position. REW are carried at this position.
The mechanism will not move any further in the loading direction.
5-56
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Display on the
adjustment
remote
commander
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
A
8
9
A (A)
B (b)
C (C)
D (d)
E (E)
B
F (F )
Address
Page
(Example)
bit3
or
bit7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit values
bit2
bit1
or
or
bit6
bit5
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
Address 42
Function
POWER SW (VTR MODE SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
POWER SW (CAM MODE SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
START/STOP SW (SS-1380 block S002)
EJECT SW (SS-1380 block S003)
CC DOWN SW (Mechanism chassis)
PHOTO FREEZE SW (SS-1380 block S004)
POWER SW (PHOTO STBY SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
Using method:
1) Select page: 2, address: 42.
2) By discriminating the bit value of display data, the state of the switch can be discriminated.
DCR-TRV340
Page 7
Bit
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Address 0E
Function
POWER SW (VTR MODE SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
POWER SW (CAM MODE SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
START/STOP SW (SS-1380 block S002)
EJECT SW (SS-1380 block S003)
CC DOWN SW (Mechanism chassis)
PHOTO FREEZE SW (SS-1380 block S004)
POWER SW (PHOTO STBY SW) (SS-1380 block S001)
Using method:
1) Select page: 7, address: 0E.
2) By discriminating the bit value of display data, the state of the switch can be discriminated.
5-57
bit0
or
bit4
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Address 81
Function
AUDIO/VIDEO jack (FP-410 flexible J201)
S VIDEO jack (FP-410 flexible J201)
MIC jack (FP-411 flexible J302)
Using method:
1) Select page: 2, address: 81.
2) By discriminating the bit value of display data, the state of the switch can be discriminated.
DCR-TRV340
Page 7
Bit
1
2
3
Address 0C
Function
AUDIO/VIDEO jack (FP-410 flexible J201)
S VIDEO jack (FP-410 flexible J201)
MIC jack (FP-411 flexible J302)
Using method:
1) Select page: 7, address: 0C.
2) By discriminating the bit value of display data, the state of the switch can be discriminated.
6. Switch check (3)
Page 3
Bit
6
Address 61
Function
HEADPHONS jack (FP-411 flexible J301)
Using method:
1) Select page: 3, address: 61.
2) By discriminating the bit value of display data, the state of the switch can be discriminated.
5-58
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Address 5C to 61
(DCR-TRV240)
Address 60 to 65
(DCR-TRV340)
Using method:
1) Select page: 2, address: 5C to 61 (TRV240) or 60 to 65 (TRV340).
2) By discriminating the display data, the pressed key can be discriminated.
Address
Data
00 to 0C
0D to 24
25 to 3F
5C/60
SUPER
(KEY AD0)
STOP
FF
NIGHT SHOT
(FK-2500)
(FK-2500)
(IC4801 <zxn )
(FK-2500)
(IC5001 tl)
(S404)
(S407)
(S401)
*1
5D/61
(KEY AD1)
PAUSE
FOCUS
BACK LIGHT
(IC4801 <zxm ) (FK-2500)
(CF-2500)
(CF-2500)
(IC5001 y;)
(S405)
(S004)
(S016)
*1
5E/62
EDIT
EDIT
(KEY AD2)
SEARCH +
SEARCH
(IC4801 <zx, )
(CF-2500)
(CF-2500)
(IC5001 ya)
(S024)
(S025)
*1
5F/63
TITLE
(KEY AD3) END SEARCH PB ZOOM
(CF-2500)
(CF-2500)
(IC4801 <zx. ) (CF-2500)
(IC5001 yg)
(S003)
(S006)
(S009)
*1
60/64
MEMORY
MEMORY
(KEY AD4)
MPEG PLAY
MIX
INDEX
(IC4801 <zc/ )
(CF-2500)
(CF-2500)
(CF-2500)
(IC5001 yh)
(S029)
(S005)
(S026) *2
*1
*2
61/65
PHOTO
PANEL
(KEY AD5)
(PHOTO START) REVERSE
(IC4801 <zcz )
(SS-1380)
(FP-412)
(IC5001 yj)
(S004)
(S601)
*1
40 to 5D
5E to 81
82 to AA
REW
(FK-2500)
(S409)
PLAY
(FK-2500)
(S403)
REC
(FK-2500)
(S406,408)
FADER
(CF-2500)
(S010)
EXPOSURE
(CF-2500)
(S027)
MENU
EXECUTE
(CF-2500)
(S007)
AB to D7
D8 to FF
No key input
PANEL
CLOSE
(CF-2500)
(S001)
PANEL OPEN
(CF-2500)
(S001)
No key input
MENU
(CF-2500)
(S012)
VOLUME +
(CF-2500)
(S015)
VOLUME
(CF-2500)
(S022)
DISPLAY
(CF-2500)
(S019)
No key input
MEMORY
DELETE
(CF-2500)
(S028)
*2
MEMORY +
(CF-2500)
(S013)
*2
MEMORY
(CF-2500)
(S017)
*2
MEMORY
PLAY
(CF-2500)
(S018)*2
No key input
PANEL
NORMAL
(FP-412)
(S601)
5-59
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
(DCR-TRV240)
Address C8 to CD
Function
User initial power
on date
(BCD code)
Final condensation
occurrence date
(BCD code)
(DCR-TRV340)
Remarks
Year
Month
Day
Year
Month
Day
Page D
Address D0 to D1
(DCR-TRV240)
Address
Function
Remarks
D0
Drum rotation counted time Hour (L) 100th place digit and 10th place digit (decimal digit)
D1
(BCD code)
Hour (H) 10000th place digit and 1000th place digit (decimal digit)
Using method:
1) The record of use data is displayed at addresses: D0, D1.
Initializing method:
1) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 01.
2) Select page: D, address D0 to D7 and set data: 00.
3) Select page: 0, address: 01, and set data: 00.
Page 7
Address A7 to A9
(DCR-TRV340)
Address
Function
Remarks
A7
Drum rotation counted time Hour (H) 100000th place digit and 10000th place digit (decimal digit)
A8
(BCD code)
Hour (M) 1000th place digit and 100th place digit (decimal digit)
A9
Hour (L) 10th place digit and 1st place digit (decimal digit)
Using method:
1) The record of use data is displayed at addresses: A7 to A9.
Initializing method:
1) Select page: 7, address: 00, set data: 71, and press PAUSE button.
2) Select page: 7, address: 01, set data: 71, and press PAUSE button.
3) Select page: 7, address: 02, and check the data is 01.
5-60
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Address B0 to C6
(DCR-TRV240)
Page 7
Address B0 to C6
(DCR-TRV340)
Address
Self-diagnosis code
B0
B1
B2
B4
B5
B6
B8
B9
BA
BC
BD
BE
C0
C1
C2
C4
C5
C6
Using method:
1) The past self-diagnosis codes are displayed at addresses: BC to C6. Refer to SELF-DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION for detail of the selfdiagnosis code.
Note: Only for DCR-TRV240 model, this data will be erased (reset) when the CF-2500 board (VC-276 board CN1110 (22P)) is removed.
5-61E
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SECTION 6
REPAIR PARTS LIST
6-1. EXPLODED VIEWS
NOTE:
-XX, -X mean standardized parts, so they may
have some differences from the original one.
Items marked * are not stocked since they
are seldom required for routine service. Some
delay should be anticipated when ordering these
items.
The mechanical parts with no reference number
in the exploded views are not supplied.
Abbreviation
CND : Canadian model
HK : Hong Kong model
KR : Korea model
JE : Tourist model
AR : Argentina model
BR : Brazilian model
13
14
Cabinet (R) section
(See page 6-5)
1
Cabinet (L) section-1,-2
(See page 6-2,6-3)
SO
NY
1
A
12
11
9
17
(TRV240 : US/
TRV340 : US)
1
10
ns
16
15
1
9
6
8
7
MIC901
5
1
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
1
2
3
4
5
3-067-347-01
3-065-310-01
X-3949-376-1
X-3952-131-1
3-072-279-01
MI SCREW M2 (H)
RING, RUBBER
CAP (N) ASSY, LENS
PANEL ASSY (24), FRONT
CUSHION (F), MICROPHONE
6
7
8
9
3-072-278-01
3-072-277-01
3-072-307-01
3-065-567-01
HOLDER, MICROPHONE
RETAINER, MICROPHONE
SHEET, MICROPHONE
TAPPING (M1.7)
Remarks
Ref. No.
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
* 17
MIC901
6-1
Part No.
Description
A-7078-047-A
1-683-627-21
3-072-309-01
3-065-326-01
3-072-271-01
3-072-343-01
3-072-344-01
3-704-367-01
1-542-477-11
COVER, JACK
RETAINER, JACK COVER
LABEL (TRV240:US/TRV340:US)
MICROPHONE
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
EVF section
(See page 6-4)
68
(TRV340)
60
59
51
61
51
51
59
69
59
D
51
62
63
57
56
51
51
55
58
G
F
E
H
I
G
F H
E
51
64
52
65
6
-27
VCard
o
B
Mechanism deck
(See page 6-7 to 6-10)
53
59
54
66
A
AB
51
51
67
51
Lens section
(See page 6-4)
51
51
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
51
52
53
54
55
4-974-725-01
3-072-267-01
3-065-662-01
3-066-169-01
3-072-268-01
SCREW (M1.7X2.5), P
FRAME, MD
LABEL, LS CAUTION
SHEET, MD
FRAME, SHOE
Remarks
56
57
57
58
59
1-680-118-11
1-815-124-11
1-815-124-21
3-072-308-01
3-067-347-01
60
Ref. No.
6-2
Part No.
Description
61
62
63
64
1-816-271-11
1-683-625-11
1-500-226-11
A-7028-802-A
64
A-7028-804-A
65
66
67
68
69
3-066-759-01
1-683-623-11
1-683-626-21
3-065-567-01
3-941-343-21
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
107
103
ns
108
110
BT901
103
104
109
103
111
112
102
106
105
ns
ns
114
101
113
103
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
101
102
103
104
105
X-3951-159-1
3-052-815-01
3-067-347-01
3-065-308-01
3-978-765-01
Remarks
106
107
107
108
109
3-713-791-01
1-476-415-11
1-476-415-21
4-974-725-01
3-941-343-21
Ref. No.
110
6-3
Part No.
Description
Remarks
110
110
111
112
113
114
BT901
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
170
154
154
169
159
153
152
IC551
M904
LCD903
168
158
155
167
157
166
156
165
162
164
154
163
ns
151
M905
160
154
161
160
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
151
152
153
154
155
8-848-740-01
X-3951-248-1
3-065-022-01
3-713-791-41
1-758-554-11
156
157
158
159
160
3-053-973-01
A-7078-046-A
3-318-203-11
1-676-822-11
3-065-567-01
161
162
Remarks
Ref. No.
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
* 170
IC551
LCD903
M904
M905
6-4
Part No.
Description
1-683-624-11
A-7078-049-A
3-065-058-01
3-072-211-01
3-072-210-01
X-3952-214-1
X-3952-132-1
3-065-376-01
A-7028-780-A
8-753-028-49
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
210
207
209
208
LCD section
(See page 6-6)
ns
202
203
202
205
202
206
204
202
201
: The printed wiring board of the Control switch block (CF-2500) on which BT001 (lithium battery) is mounted, is not shown.
CAUTION :
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type.
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
201
202
203
203
204
3-941-343-21
3-948-339-61
1-477-085-11
1-477-085-21
3-065-373-01
TAPE (A)
TAPPING
SWITCH BLOCK, CONTROL (CF-2500)(TRV240)
SWITCH BLOCK, CONTROL (CF-2500)(TRV340)
SCREW (Y), TRIPOD
Remarks
205
206
Ref. No.
6-5
Part No.
Description
207
207
208
209
210
X-3952-129-1
X-3952-135-1
3-959-978-02
1-477-084-31
X-3952-133-1
Remarks
210
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
265
256
261
263
B
266
260
258
257
262
LCD901
256
259
PD
Bo -16
ard 0
ND901
264
255
253
D902
LCD902
252
251
Ref. No.
254
Part No.
Description
251
252
252
253
254
3-072-272-01
X-3952-189-1
X-3952-192-1
3-072-341-01
1-683-629-11
WINDOW, LCD
COVER (2) ASSY, CPC (TRV340)
COVER (2) ASSY, CPC (TRV240)
CABINET (C (2)), P
FP-414 FLEXIBLE BOARD
255
256
257
258
259
3-072-286-01
4-974-725-01
A-7078-052-A
1-961-556-11
3-318-203-11
HOLDER, LCD
SCREW (M1.7X2.5), P
PD-160 (X6) BOARD, COMPLETE
HARNESS (PD-117)
SCREW (B1.7X6), TAPPING
260
Remarks
Ref. No.
261
262
263
264
265
266
0 D902
LCD901
LCD902
0 ND901
6-6
Part No.
Description
1-683-628-22
X-3952-147-1
3-072-287-01
3-072-403-01
X-3952-150-1
3-065-567-01
1-518-721-11
8-753-050-65
A-7028-811-A
1-518-796-11
TAPPING (M1.7)
LIGHT, BACK
ACX308AK-1
INDICATION LCD BLOCK ASSY
TUBE, FLUORESCENT,COLD CATHODE
Note :
The components identified by
mark 0 or dotted line with mark
0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number
specified.
Remarks
Note :
Les composants identifis par
une marque 0 sont critiques
pour la scurit.
Ne les remplacer que par une
pice portant le numro spcifi.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
701
702
701
703
705
706
708
LS chassis block
assembly
(See page 6-8)
M901
704
707
709
712
711
710
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
701
702
703
704
705
3-065-932-01
3-065-895-01
3-065-896-01
X-3951-298-1
X-3951-302-1
706
707
Remarks
Ref. No.
6-7
Part No.
Description
708
709
710
711
712
3-065-935-01
3-947-503-01
X-3951-299-1
3-074-309-01
7-624-101-04
M901
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
759
757
760
767
S001
764
766
758
768
763
769
765
770
761
762
756
771
755
772
781
752
S002
ns
Q001
775
778
780
776
H001
779
774
D001
H002
LS-057
ns
777
Q002
773
FP-301
ns
FP-300
ns
FP-302
ns
ns
754
753
752
783
751
782
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
751
752
753
754
755
3-065-822-02
3-947-503-01
A-7096-416-B
A-7096-415-A
A-7096-426-A
756
757
758
759
760
3-065-802-01
A-7096-414-A
3-065-801-01
3-065-932-01
X-3951-303-1
761
762
763
764
765
766
767
768
769
770
Remarks
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
771
772
773
774
775
3-065-830-01
X-3951-288-1
3-065-819-01
3-065-821-01
X-3951-289-1
SPRING, S RATCHET
TABLE (T) ASSY, REEL
SPRING, TG1 ARM
RAIL (T), GUIDE
TABLE (S) ASSY, REEL
776
777
778
779
780
3-065-833-01
3-065-831-01
X-3951-304-1
3-065-835-01
3-065-820-01
GUIDE, LOCK
PLATE (SPR), RE RETURN
ARM ASSY, TG1
GUIDE (S), CASSETTE
SPRING, RVS ARM
3-065-823-01
3-065-794-01
3-065-792-01
3-065-834-01
3-065-824-01
ARM, T RATCHET
ROAD (SPR), PINCH ARM
ROLLER, P LIM ARM
GUIDE (T), CASSETTE
SPRING, T RATCHET
781
782
783
D001
H001
X-3951-296-1
3-065-836-01
3-067-167-01
8-719-988-42
8-719-033-37
BAND (ASSY), BT
COVER, LS GREASE
SCREW (M1.4X2), CAMERA TAPPING
DIODE GL453 (TAPE LED)
ELEMENT, HALL HW-105C (T REEL)
A-7096-417-A
7-627-852-38
3-065-832-01
3-065-828-01
3-065-829-01
SOFT ASSY, T
SCREW,PRECISION +P1.7X1.8TYPE3
PLATE, LS CAM
ARM, S RATCHET
PLATE, S RATCHET (RE)
H002
Q001
Q002
S001
8-719-033-37
8-729-907-25
8-729-907-25
1-692-614-11
6-8
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
816
811
805
815
819
824
809
817
805
815
810
ns
814
802
807
813
M902
812
815
802
821
820
M903
822
806
823
802
808
818
804
803
Mechanical chassis
block assembly-2
(See page 6-10)
801
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
Part No.
Description
801
802
803
804
805
A-7096-422-A
3-947-503-01
3-065-928-01
3-065-927-01
3-065-932-01
Remarks
Ref. No.
814
815
816
817
818
3-065-881-01
3-065-934-01
1-786-096-11
3-065-898-01
3-065-870-01
806
807
808
809
810
3-067-154-01
3-065-931-01
X-3947-398-1
3-065-933-01
1-677-049-11
SPRING, CAPSTAN
RAIL (T2), GUIDE
SCREW ASSY, M1.7 PW
PAN (2 MAIN 1.4X4.5), CAMERA
FP-228 FLEXIBLE BOARD (DEW SENSOR)
819
820
821
822
823
A-7096-421-A
3-065-918-01
A-7096-419-A
3-065-902-01
3-065-905-01
811
812
813
824
M902
M903
6-9
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
860
863
861
859
857
862
864
858
865
856
855
853
866
854
852
851
867
868
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
851
852
853
854
855
3-065-920-01
3-065-913-01
3-065-914-01
3-065-917-01
3-065-934-01
ARM, HC DRIVE
GEAR (4), LD
SHEET, COVER
GEAR (1), CAM RELAY
HLW CUT 0.98X3X0.25
856
857
858
859
3-065-915-01
3-065-878-01
3-065-932-01
A-7096-413-A
Remarks
Ref. No.
6-10
Part No.
Description
860
861
862
863
864
7-624-101-04
A-7096-412-A
X-3951-307-1
X-3951-305-1
3-065-901-01
865
866
867
868
3-065-916-01
3-065-919-01
X-3951-308-1
X-3951-300-2
Remarks
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
CD-357
LB-076
PD-160
Part No.
RESISTORS
All resistors are in ohms.
METAL: metal-film resistor
METAL OXIDE: Metal Oxide-film resistor
F: nonflammable
SEMICONDUCTORS
In each case, u: , for example:
uA...: A... , uPA... , PA... ,
uPB... , PB... , uPC... , PC... ,
uPD..., PD...
Abbreviation
CND : Canadian model
HK : Hong Kong model
KR : Korea model
Description
Remarks
Ref. No.
Part No.
JE
AR
BR
: Tourist model
: Argentina model
: Brazilian model
Description
Remarks
1-113-985-11
1-113-682-11
1-164-360-11
1-162-970-11
TANTAL. CHIP
TANTAL. CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
10uF
33uF
0.1uF
0.01uF
20%
20%
10%
20V
10V
16V
25V
2.2uF
16V
< IC >
1-414-445-11 FERRITE
IC701
8-759-581-11 IC NJM2125F(TE2)
0uH
< IC >
IC551
Q701
Q702
8-759-054-48 TRANSISTOR
8-729-054-45 TRANSISTOR
UP04601008S0
UP04312008S0
L552
1-469-528-91 INDUCTOR
R701
R702
R703
R704
R706
100uH
8-729-117-73 TRANSISTOR
1-218-940-11
1-218-959-11
1-218-977-11
1-218-989-11
1-218-990-11
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
SHORT
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
33K
180K
3.3K
22
33K
0.5%
0.5%
5%
0.5%
5%
1/10W
1/10W
1/16W
1/10W
1/16W
2SC4178-F13F14-T1
R707
1-218-867-11 RES-CHIP
6.8K
5%
1/10W
************************************************************
1-218-883-11
1-218-901-11
1-216-827-11
1-211-977-11
1-216-839-11
82
3.3K
100K
1M
0
5%
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
R564
1-218-990-11 SHORT
0
R567
1-218-990-11 SHORT
0
R568
1-218-990-11 SHORT
0
R569
1-216-864-11 METAL CHIP
0
5%
1/16W
************************************************************
6-11
C5501
C5504
C5505
C5506
C5507
1-127-760-11
1-164-943-11
1-164-943-11
1-164-943-11
1-164-943-11
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
4.7uF
0.01uF
0.01uF
0.01uF
0.01uF
10%
10%
10%
10%
10%
6.3V
16V
16V
16V
16V
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
PD-160
Ref. No.
SI-032
Part No.
Description
C5509
C5510
C5511
C5512
C5515
1-110-457-11
1-164-943-11
1-164-739-11
1-125-777-11
1-162-964-11
ELECT CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
3.3uF
0.01uF
560PF
0.1uF
0.001uF
20%
10%
5%
10%
10%
25V
16V
50V
10V
50V
Remarks
C5516
C5517
C5518
C5519
C5532
1-164-872-11
1-109-982-11
1-109-982-11
1-109-982-11
1-109-982-11
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
82PF
1uF
1uF
1uF
1uF
5%
10%
10%
10%
10%
50V
10V
10V
10V
10V
C5533
C5534
C5536
C5538
C5540
1-115-566-11
1-109-982-11
1-125-777-11
1-164-943-11
1-107-826-11
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
4.7uF
1uF
0.1uF
0.01uF
0.1uF
10%
10%
10%
10%
10%
10V
10V
10V
16V
16V
C5602
C5604
C5605
C5606
0 C5607
1-115-566-11
1-164-657-11
1-125-777-11
1-125-777-11
1-131-959-91
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
4.7uF
0.015uF
0.1uF
0.1uF
12PF
10%
10%
10%
10%
10%
10V
50V
10V
10V
3KV
0.1uF
10%
10V
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
Remarks
8-759-054-48
8-729-052-65
8-729-041-23
8-729-052-64
8-759-054-48
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
Q5601
Q5602
8-729-052-64 TRANSISTOR
6-550-083-01 TRANSISTOR
UP04601008S0
2SA1774HT2L
NDS356AP
DTC144EHT2L
UP04601008S0
DTC144EHT2L
TPC6C01(TE85R)
C5701
CN5501
* CN5502
CN5601
CN5701
CN5702
1-815-031-11
1-573-984-11
1-764-709-11
1-794-998-31
1-816-176-11
R5501
R5503
R5506
R5507
R5508
1-218-985-11
1-208-935-11
1-218-958-11
1-218-973-11
1-218-975-11
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
470K
100K
2.7K
47K
68K
5%
0.5%
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
R5509
R5510
R5511
R5512
R5522
1-218-969-11
1-218-975-11
1-218-989-11
1-218-977-11
1-218-969-11
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
22K
68K
1M
100K
22K
5%
5%
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
R5551
R5572
R5573
R5574
R5575
1-218-973-11
1-218-965-11
1-218-965-11
1-208-957-11
1-218-975-11
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
47K
10K
10K
820K
68K
5%
5%
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
R5576
R5577
R5579
R5590
R5609
1-218-989-11
1-218-985-11
1-218-979-11
1-218-990-11
1-218-965-11
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
SHORT
RES-CHIP
1M
470K
150K
0
10K
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
5%
1/16W
R5610
R5611
R5612
R5614
R5617
1-216-055-00
1-218-980-11
1-218-969-11
1-218-965-11
1-218-969-11
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
1.8K
180K
22K
10K
22K
5%
5%
5%
5%
5%
1/10W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
R5618
R5704
1-218-949-11 RES-CHIP
1-218-987-11 RES-CHIP
470
680K
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
0uH
0uH
(1005)
< IC >
< TRANSFORMER >
IC5501
IC5502
IC5601
IC5602
IC5701
8-752-100-95
8-752-407-33
8-759-564-49
8-759-075-70
8-759-573-02
IC
IC
IC
IC
IC
CXA3289AR-T4
CXD3512R-T4
TC7W53FU(TE12R)
TA75S393F-TE85R
BU9735K-E2
1-469-527-91
1-412-956-21
1-419-387-21
1-412-056-11
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
47uH
27uH
100uH
4.7uH
6-12
C305
C310
C311
C312
C314
1-107-826-11
1-107-826-11
1-104-847-11
1-104-847-11
1-162-969-11
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
TANTAL. CHIP
TANTAL. CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
C315
0.1uF
0.1uF
22uF
22uF
0.0068uF
10%
10%
20%
20%
10%
16V
16V
4V
4V
25V
0.0068uF 10%
25V
Note :
Les composants identifis par
une marque 0 sont critiques
pour la scurit.
Ne les remplacer que par une
pice portant le numro spcifi.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
SI-032
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
Remarks
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
VC-276
Remarks
************************************************************
D301
D302
D303
D304
D306
8-719-067-44
8-719-067-44
8-719-062-16
8-719-056-85
8-719-074-30
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
CL-310IRS-X-TU
CL-310IRS-X-TU
01ZA8.2(TPL3)
UDZSTE-178.2B
SML-310LTT86
D309
D313
1-414-760-21 FERRITE
1-414-760-21 FERRITE
0uH
0uH
< IC >
IC301
6-701-681-01 IC NJL61H400A
< TRANSISTOR >
Q301
8-729-141-73 TRANSISTOR
2SD1938(F)-S(TX).SO
1-216-810-11
1-216-864-11
1-216-817-11
1-216-019-00
1-216-019-00
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
120
0
470
56
56
5%
5%
5%
5%
5%
1/16W
1/16W
1/16W
1/10W
1/10W
6-13
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Ref. No.
Part No.
Description
Remarks
ACCESSORIES
***********
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note :
The components identified by
mark 0 or dotted line with mark
0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number
specified.
Note :
Les composants identifis par
une marque 0 sont critiques
pour la scurit.
Ne les remplacer que par une
pice portant le numro spcifi.
6-26E
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
OPTICAL
AXIS FRAME
206
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
FOR
207
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
9-929-932-31
208
2003J1600-1
2003.10
Published by DI CS Strategy Div.
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
RMT-814
US Model
Canadian Model
E Model
Hong Kong Model
SERVICE MANUAL
DCR-TRV240/TRV340
Level 2
Korea Model
Tourist Model
Argentina Model
Brazilian Model
SUPPLEMENT-1
DCR-TRV340
CD-357 BOARD
Before changed
1-683-618-11
1-683-618-21
After changed
1-683-618-12
1-683-618-22
CD-357 BOARD
Added portion.
CD-357 BOARD
4-7
9-929-932-81
2003D1600-1
2003.4
Published by DI Customer Center
Reverse
992993234.pdf
Revision History
History
Contents
S.M. Rev.
issued
Ver.
Date
1.0
2002.01
Official Release
1.1
2002.06
Correction-1
Yes
1.2
2003.04
Supplement-1
No
1.3
2003.10
Correction-1
Yes